drivers: call adapter_get_required_serial() in jtag_libusb_open()
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2375 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @section Interface Drivers
2379
2380 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2381 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2382 available at run time.
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2385 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2386 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2387 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2390 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2391 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2395 Displays status of RTCK option.
2396 Optionally sets that option first.
2397 @end deffn
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2401 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2402 This has one driver-specific command:
2403
2404 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2405 Logs some status
2406 @end deffn
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2410 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2411 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2412 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2413 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2414 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2418 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2419 or v2 (USB bulk).
2420
2421 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2422 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2423 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2424 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2425 @example
2426 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2427 @end example
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2431 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2432
2433 @itemize @minus
2434 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2435 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2436 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2437 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2438 @end itemize
2439 @end deffn
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2442 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2443 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2444 interface string or for user class interface.
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2448 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2449 @end deffn
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2453 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2457 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2458 @end deffn
2459
2460 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2461 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2462 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2463
2464 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2465 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2466
2467 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2468 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2469
2470 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2471 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2472 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2473 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2474 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2475 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2476
2477 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2478 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2479 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2480 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2481 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2482
2483 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2484 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2485 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2486 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2487
2488 @itemize @minus
2489 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2490 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2491 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2492 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2493 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2494 switching data and direction as necessary
2495 @end itemize
2496
2497 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2498 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2501 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2502 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2503 @example
2504 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2505 @end example
2506 @end deffn
2507
2508 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2509 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2510 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2511 during device selection.
2512 @end deffn
2513
2514 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2515 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2516 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2517 @end deffn
2518
2519 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2520 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2521 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2522 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2523 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2524 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2525 and initially asserted reset signals.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2529 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2530 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2531 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2532 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2533 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2534 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2535 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2536 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2537 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2538 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2539
2540 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2541 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2542 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2543 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2544 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2545 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2546
2547 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2548 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2549 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2550 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2551 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2552 are always driven by the FTDI.
2553
2554 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2555 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2556 @var{name}.
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2560 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2561 @itemize @minus
2562 @item @option{0}, drive low
2563 @item @option{1}, drive high
2564 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2565 @end itemize
2566 @end deffn
2567
2568 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2569 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2573 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2574
2575 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2576 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2577 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2578 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2579 @itemize @minus
2580 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2581 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2582 @end itemize
2583 @end deffn
2584
2585 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2586 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2587
2588 @end deffn
2589
2590 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2591 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2592 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2593 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2594
2595 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2596 @itemize @minus
2597 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2598 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2599 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2600 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2601 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2602 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2603 @end itemize
2604
2605 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2606 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2607 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2608 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2609 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2610 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2611 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2612 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2613
2614 FT232R
2615 @itemize @minus
2616 @item bit 7 - RI
2617 @item bit 6 - DCD
2618 @item bit 5 - DSR
2619 @item bit 4 - DTR
2620 @item bit 3 - CTS
2621 @item bit 2 - RTS
2622 @item bit 1 - RXD
2623 @item bit 0 - TXD
2624 @end itemize
2625
2626 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2627 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2628
2629 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2630 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2631 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2632 @end deffn
2633
2634 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2635 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2636 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2637 @end deffn
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2640 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2644 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2645 @end deffn
2646
2647 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2648 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2652 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2656 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2660 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2664 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2665 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2666 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2667 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2668 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2669 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2670 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2671 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2672 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @end deffn
2676
2677 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2678 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2679 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2680 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2681
2682 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2683 processors which are being simulated.
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2686 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2687 sockets instead of TCP.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2691 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2692 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2696 something like:
2697
2698 @example
2699 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2700 remote_bitbang port 3335
2701 remote_bitbang host foobar
2702 @end example
2703
2704 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2705 named mysocket:
2706
2707 @example
2708 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2709 remote_bitbang port 0
2710 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2711 @end example
2712 @end deffn
2713
2714 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2715 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2716 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2717 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2718
2719 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2720 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2721 default values are used.
2722 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2723 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2724 @example
2725 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2726 @end example
2727 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2728 @example
2729 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2730 @end example
2731 @end deffn
2732
2733 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2734 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2735 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2736 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2737 target board.
2738
2739 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2740 @example
2741 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2742 reset_config srst_only
2743 @end example
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2747 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2748 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2749 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2753 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2754 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2755 @end deffn
2756
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2760 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2761 This has one driver-specific command:
2762
2763 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2764 Display either the address of the I/O port
2765 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2766 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2767 This is a write-once setting.
2768 @end deffn
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2772 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2773 transports.
2774
2775 @quotation Compatibility Note
2776 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2777 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2778 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2779 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2780 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2781 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2782 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2783 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2784 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2785 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2786 @end quotation
2787
2788 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2789 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2790 states.
2791 @end deffn
2792 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2793 Display free device internal memory.
2794 @end deffn
2795 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2796 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2797 command version.
2798 @end deffn
2799 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2800 Display the device configuration.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2803 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2804 power state.
2805 @end deffn
2806 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2807 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2810 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2811 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2812 IP configuration.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2815 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2816 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2819 Reset the current configuration.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2822 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2825 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2826 pairs.
2827
2828 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2829 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2830 @example
2831 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2832 @end example
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2835 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2836 pairs.
2837
2838 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2839 @example
2840 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2841 77a90000
2842 @end example
2843 @end deffn
2844 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2845 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2846 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2847 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2848 the serial number instead, if possible.
2849
2850 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2851 @end deffn
2852 @end deffn
2853
2854 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2855 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2856 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2857 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2858 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2859 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2860 configuration script.
2861
2862 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2863 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2864 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2865 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2866 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2867
2868 Known limitations:
2869 @itemize @bullet
2870 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2871 and 2.7 MHz.
2872 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2873 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2874 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2875 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2876 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2877 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2878 communications with the target.
2879 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2880 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2881 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2882 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2883 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2884 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2885 @end itemize
2886
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2888 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2889 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2893 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2894 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2895 target as a side-effect.
2896 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2900 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2901 version, and target voltage.
2902 @end deffn
2903 @end deffn
2904
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2906 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2907 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2908 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2909 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2910
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2912 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2913 This is a write-once setting.
2914 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2915
2916 @itemize @minus
2917 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2918 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2919 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2920 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2921 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2922 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2923 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2924 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2925 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2926 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2927 some versions of
2928 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2929 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2930 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2931 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2932 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2933 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2934 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2935 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2936 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2937 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2938 @end itemize
2939 @end deffn
2940
2941 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2942 Display either the address of the I/O port
2943 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2944 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2945 This is a write-once setting.
2946
2947 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2948 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2949 you may encounter a problem.
2950 @end deffn
2951
2952 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2953 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2954 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2955 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2956 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2957 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2958
2959 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2960 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2961 @quotation Tip
2962 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2963 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2964 @example
2965 > parport toggling_time 1000
2966 > adapter speed 500
2967 @end example
2968 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2969 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2970 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2971 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2972 large set of samples.
2973 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2974 @example
2975 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2976 @end example
2977 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2978 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2979
2980 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2981 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2982 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2983 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2984 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2985 be conservative.
2986 @end quotation
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2990 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2991 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2992 @end deffn
2993
2994 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2995 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2996
2997 @example
2998 adapter driver parport
2999 parport port 0x278
3000 parport cable wiggler
3001 @end example
3002 @end deffn
3003
3004 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3005 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3006 @end deffn
3007
3008 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3009 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3010 @end deffn
3011
3012 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3013 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3017 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3018
3019 @quotation Note
3020 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3021 which are not currently documented here.
3022 @end quotation
3023 @end deffn
3024
3025 @anchor{hla_interface}
3026 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3027 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3028 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3029 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3030
3031 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3032 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3033 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3034 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3035 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3036 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3037
3038 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3039 Currently Not Supported.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3043 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3044 @end deffn
3045
3046 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3047 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3051 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3052 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3053
3054 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3055 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3056 ST-LINK server software module}.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3060 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3061 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3062 @end deffn
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3067 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3068 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3069 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3070
3071 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3072 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3073 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3074 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3075
3076 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3077 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3078
3079 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3080 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3081 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3082
3083 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3084 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3085 ST-LINK server software module}.
3086
3087 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3088 @end deffn
3089
3090 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3091 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3095 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3096 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3097
3098 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3099 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3100 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3101 the target's supply voltage.
3102 @example
3103 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3104 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3105 @end example
3106 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3107 @example
3108 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3109 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3110 3.24891518738
3111 @end example
3112 @end deffn
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3116 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3117 @end deffn
3118
3119 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3120 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3121 @end deffn
3122
3123 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3124 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3125 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3126 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3127 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3130 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3131 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3132 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3136 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3137 version).
3138 @end deffn
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3142 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3143 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3144 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3145 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3146
3147 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3148
3149 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3150 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3151
3152 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3153 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3154
3155 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3156
3157 @end deffn
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3161 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3162 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3163
3164 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3165 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3166 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3167 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3168 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3169 configuration on exit.
3170
3171 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3172
3173 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3174 pinout.
3175
3176 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3177 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3178 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3179 individually.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3183 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3184 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3185 @end deffn
3186
3187 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3188 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3189 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3190 @end deffn
3191
3192 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3193 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3194 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3198 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3199 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3200 @end deffn
3201
3202 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3203 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3204 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3205 @end deffn
3206
3207 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3208 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3209 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3213 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3214 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3215 @end deffn
3216
3217 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3218 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3219 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3220 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3221 @end deffn
3222
3223 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3224 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3225 @end deffn
3226
3227 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3228 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3232 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3233 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3234 @end deffn
3235
3236 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3237 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3238 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3239 list can be found in the
3240 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3246 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3247 of the one which is most popular.
3248
3249 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3250
3251 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3252 pinout.
3253
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256
3257 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3258 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3259 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3260
3261 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3266 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3267 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3268
3269 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3270 @end deffn
3271
3272
3273 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3274 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3275 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3276
3277 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3278 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3279 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3280
3281 @itemize @minus
3282 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3283 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3284 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3285 @end itemize
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3289 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3290 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3291 @end deffn
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294
3295 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3296 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3297 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3298 DPI server interface.
3299
3300 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3301 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3302 @end deffn
3303
3304 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3305 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3306 @end deffn
3307 @end deffn
3308
3309
3310 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3311
3312 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3313 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3314
3315 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3316 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3317
3318 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3319 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3320 @example
3321 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3322 @end example
3323 @end deffn
3324
3325 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3326 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3327 @example
3328 buspirate speed normal
3329 @end example
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3333 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3334 @itemize @minus
3335 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3336 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3337 @end itemize
3338 For example:
3339 @example
3340 buspirate mode normal
3341 @end example
3342 @end deffn
3343
3344 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3345 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3346 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3347 For example:
3348 @example
3349 buspirate pullup 0
3350 @end example
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3354 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3355 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3356 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3357 @example
3358 buspirate vreg 0
3359 @end example
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3363 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3364 @end deffn
3365 @example
3366 buspirate led 1
3367 @end example
3368
3369 @end deffn
3370
3371
3372 @section Transport Configuration
3373 @cindex Transport
3374 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3375 and the debug adapter you are using,
3376 several transports may be available to
3377 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3378 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3379 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3380 version of OpenOCD.
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3384 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3385
3386 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3387 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3388 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3389 adapter's driver).
3390
3391 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3392 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3393 supported by the debug adapter.
3394
3395 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3396 transport, if any.
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @subsection JTAG Transport
3400 @cindex JTAG
3401 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3402 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3403 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3404 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3405 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3406 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3407
3408 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3409 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3410 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3411 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3412 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3413
3414 @subsection SWD Transport
3415 @cindex SWD
3416 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3417 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3418 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3419 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3420 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3421 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3422 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3423
3424 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3425 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3426 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3427 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3428 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3429
3430 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3431 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3432 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3433 expected to change.
3434 @end deffn
3435
3436 @subsection SPI Transport
3437 @cindex SPI
3438 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3439 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3440 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3441 solution for flash programming.
3442
3443 @anchor{swimtransport}
3444 @subsection SWIM Transport
3445 @cindex SWIM
3446 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3447 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3448 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3449 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3450
3451 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3452
3453 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3454
3455 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3456 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3457 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3458 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3459 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3460
3461 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3462 @section JTAG Speed
3463 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3464 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3465 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3466 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3467 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3468 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3469 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3470 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3471 power management software that may be active.
3472
3473 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3474 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3475 target event handler.
3476 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3477 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3478 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3479 sets up those clocks).
3480 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3481 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3482 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3483 in the target config file.
3484 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3485 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3486 config file instead.
3487 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3488 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3489 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3490
3491 @example
3492 jtag_rclk 3000
3493 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3494 @end example
3495
3496 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3497 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3498 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3499 may not be the fastest solution.
3500
3501 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3502 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3503 which support adaptive clocking.
3504
3505 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3506 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3507 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3508 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3509 than the speed specified.
3510
3511 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3512 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3513 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3514 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3515
3516 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3517 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3518 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3519 JTAG clocking after setup.
3520 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3521 If the interface device can not
3522 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3523 @end deffn
3524
3525 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3526 @cindex adaptive clocking
3527 @cindex RTCK
3528 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3529 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3530 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3531 @example
3532 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3533 jtag_rclk 3000
3534 @end example
3535 @end defun
3536
3537 @node Reset Configuration
3538 @chapter Reset Configuration
3539 @cindex Reset Configuration
3540
3541 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3542 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3543 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3544 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3545 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3546 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3547 Please see the various board files for examples.
3548
3549 @quotation Note
3550 To maintainers and integrators:
3551 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3552 Normally the board configuration file
3553 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3554 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3555
3556 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3557 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3558 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3559 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3560 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3561 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3562 @end quotation
3563
3564 @section Types of Reset
3565
3566 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3567 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3568 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3569
3570 @itemize @bullet
3571 @item
3572 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3573 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3574 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3575 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3576 @item
3577 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3578 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3579 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3580 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3581 @item
3582 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3583 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3584 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3585 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3586 @item
3587 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3588 several other types of reset.
3589 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3590 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3591 There may be individual module resets.
3592 @end itemize
3593
3594 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3595 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3596 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3597 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3598 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3599 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3600 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3601 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3602 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3603
3604 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3605 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3606
3607 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3608 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3609 common issues are:
3610
3611 @itemize @bullet
3612
3613 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3614 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3615 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3616 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3617 when either of those signals is not connected.
3618 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3619 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3620 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3621 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3622
3623 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3624 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3625 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3626 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3627
3628 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3629 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3630 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3631 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3632 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3633 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3634 hardware debouncing.
3635 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3636 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3637
3638 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3639 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3640 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3641 to use push/pull output drivers.
3642 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3643 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3644 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3645 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3646
3647 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3648 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3649 issues (not limited to errata).
3650 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3651 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3652 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3653 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3654 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3655 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3656 @end itemize
3657
3658 There can also be other issues.
3659 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3660 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3661 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3662 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3663 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3664 Agreement (NDA).
3665
3666 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3667 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3668 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3669
3670 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3671 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3672
3673 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3674
3675 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3676 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3677 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3678 allowing it to be deasserted.
3679 @end deffn
3680
3681 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3682 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3683 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3684 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3685 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3686 @end deffn
3687
3688 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3689 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3690 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3691 allowing it to be deasserted.
3692 @end deffn
3693
3694 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3695 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3696 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3697 @end deffn
3698
3699 @anchor{reset_config}
3700 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3701 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3702 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3703 configuration scripts.
3704
3705 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3706 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3707 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3708 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3709 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3710 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3711 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3712 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3713
3714 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3715 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3716 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3717 -- may be specified at a time.
3718 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3719 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3720 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3721 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3722 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3723
3724 @itemize
3725 @item
3726 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3727 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3728 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3729 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3730 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3731
3732 @quotation Tip
3733 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3734 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3735 @end quotation
3736
3737 @item
3738 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3739 signal implementations.
3740 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3741 indicating everything behaves normally.
3742 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3743 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3744 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3745 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3746 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3747 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3748 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3749
3750 @item
3751 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3752 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3753 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3754 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3755 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3756 while SRST is asserted.
3757 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3758 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3759
3760 @item
3761 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3762 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3763 is required to use this option.
3764 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3765 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3766 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3767 be asserted before any target connection.
3768 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3769 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3770 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3771 @end itemize
3772
3773 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3774 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3775 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3776 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3777 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3778
3779 @itemize
3780 @item
3781 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3782 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3783 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3784 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3785
3786 @item
3787 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3788 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3789 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3790 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3791 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3792 @end itemize
3793 @end deffn
3794
3795 @section Custom Reset Handling
3796 @cindex events
3797
3798 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3799 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3800 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3801 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3802 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3803 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3804
3805 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3806 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3807 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3808 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3809 want to reset everything at once.
3810
3811 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3812 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3813 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3814 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3815 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3816 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3817 needs special attention.
3818
3819 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3820 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3821 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3822 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3823 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3824 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3825 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3826 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3827 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3828
3829 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3830 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3831 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3832 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3833 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3834
3835 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3836 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3837 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3838 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3839 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3840 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3841 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3842 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3843 or potentially some other value.
3844
3845 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3846 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3847 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3848 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3849 (or their associated targets)
3850 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3851
3852 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3853 they return.
3854 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3855 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3856 @end deffn
3857
3858 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3859 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3860 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3861 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3862 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3863 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3864 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3865 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3866 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3867 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3868 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3869 @end deffn
3870
3871 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3872 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3873 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3874 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3875 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3876 @end deffn
3877
3878
3879 @node TAP Declaration
3880 @chapter TAP Declaration
3881 @cindex TAP declaration
3882 @cindex TAP configuration
3883
3884 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3885 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3886
3887 @itemize @bullet
3888 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3889 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3890 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3891 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3892 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3893 start running that code.
3894 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3895 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3896 and missing connections.
3897 @end itemize
3898
3899 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3900 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3901 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3902 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3903 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3904
3905 @section Scan Chains
3906 @cindex scan chain
3907
3908 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3909 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3910 They also need to be added to
3911 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3912 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3913 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3914 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3915 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3916 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3917 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3918 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3919
3920 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3921 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3922 command, presented in the next chapter.
3923 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3924 debugging targets.)
3925 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3926
3927 @verbatim
3928 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3929 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3930 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3931 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3932 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3933 @end verbatim
3934
3935 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3936 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3937 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3938 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3939 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3940 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3941 until they are told to do so.
3942
3943 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3944 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3945 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3946 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3947
3948 @example
3949 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3950 @end example
3951
3952 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3953 by a given chip.
3954 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3955 and so forth.
3956 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3957 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3958 both inside a single chip and between them.
3959 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3960
3961 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3962 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3963 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3964 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3965 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3966 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3967 includes commands something like this:
3968
3969 @example
3970 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3971 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3972 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3973 @end example
3974
3975 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3976 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3977 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3978
3979 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3980 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3981 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3982 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3983 @example
3984 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3985 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3986 @}
3987 @end example
3988 @end deffn
3989
3990 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3991 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3992 and their status.
3993 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3994 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3995 but systems with a JTAG router can
3996 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3997 @end deffn
3998
3999 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4000 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4001
4002 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4003 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4004
4005 @section TAP Names
4006 @cindex dotted name
4007
4008 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4009 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4010 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4011 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4012 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4013 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4014 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4015 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4016
4017 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4018 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4019 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4020
4021 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4022
4023 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4024 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4025 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4026
4027 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4028 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4029 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4030 overridable.
4031
4032 @cindex TAP naming convention
4033 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4034 and should follow this convention:
4035
4036 @itemize @bullet
4037 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4038 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4039 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4040 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4041 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4042 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4043 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4044 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4045 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4046 with a single TAP;
4047 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4048 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4049 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4050 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4051 @end itemize
4052
4053 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4054
4055 @itemize @bullet
4056 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4057 @*The length in bits of the
4058 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4059 @end itemize
4060
4061 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4062
4063 @itemize @bullet
4064 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4065 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4066 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4067 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4068 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4069 (the TAP is linked in).
4070 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4071 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4072 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4073 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4074 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4075 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4076 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4077 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4078 values that were found but not included in the list.
4079
4080 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4081 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4082 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4083 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4084 hardware to find these values.
4085 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4086 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4087 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4088 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4089 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4090 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4091 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4092 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4093 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4094 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4095 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4096 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4097 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4098 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4099 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4100 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4101 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4102 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4103 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4104 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4105 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4106 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4107 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4108 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4109 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4110 @end itemize
4111 @end deffn
4112
4113 @section Other TAP commands
4114
4115 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4116 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4117 @end deffn
4118
4119 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4120 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4121 At this writing this TAP attribute
4122 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4123 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4124 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4125 See the next section for information about the available events.
4126
4127 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4128 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4129 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4130 @end deffn
4131
4132 @section TAP Events
4133 @cindex events
4134 @cindex TAP events
4135
4136 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4137 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4138 The other applies to debugger targets,
4139 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4140
4141 The TAP events currently defined are:
4142
4143 @itemize @bullet
4144 @item @b{post-reset}
4145 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4146 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4147 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4148 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4149 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4150
4151 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4152 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4153 of any particular target.
4154 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4155 @item @b{setup}
4156 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4157 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4158 @item @b{tap-disable}
4159 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4160 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4161 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4162 @item @b{tap-enable}
4163 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4164 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4165 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4166 @end itemize
4167
4168 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4169 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4170 contents to be accurate), you might:
4171
4172 @example
4173 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4174 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4175 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4176 @}
4177 @end example
4178
4179
4180 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4181 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4182 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4183 @cindex jrc
4184
4185 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4186 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4187 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4188 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4189 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4190
4191 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4192 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4193 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4194 be visible.
4195 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4196 ignores, such as:
4197
4198 @itemize
4199 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4200 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4201 TAPs receive new instructions.
4202 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4203 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4204 @end itemize
4205
4206 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4207 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4208 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4209 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4210
4211 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4212 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4213
4214 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4215 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4216 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4217 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4218 should define TAP event handlers using
4219 code that looks something like this:
4220
4221 @example
4222 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4223 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4224 @}
4225 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4226 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4227 @}
4228 @end example
4229
4230 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4231
4232 @example
4233 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4234 @end example
4235
4236 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4237 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4238 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4239 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4240
4241 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4242 If necessary, disables the tap
4243 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4244 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4245 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4246 and "0" if it is disabled.
4247 @end deffn
4248
4249 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4250 If necessary, enables the tap
4251 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4252 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4253 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4254 and "0" if it is disabled.
4255 @end deffn
4256
4257 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4258 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4259 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4260 and "0" if it is disabled.
4261
4262 @quotation Note
4263 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4264 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4265 @end quotation
4266 @end deffn
4267
4268 @anchor{autoprobing}
4269 @section Autoprobing
4270 @cindex autoprobe
4271 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4272
4273 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4274 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4275 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4276 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4277
4278 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4279 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4280 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4281 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4282 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4283 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4284 right when they come out of reset).
4285
4286 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4287
4288 @example
4289 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4290 reset_config trst_and_srst
4291 jtag_rclk 8
4292 @end example
4293
4294 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4295 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4296
4297 @enumerate
4298 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4299 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4300 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4301 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4302 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4303 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4304 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4305 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4306 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4307 that is discovered.
4308 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4309 register, it will report it.
4310 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4311 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4312 @end enumerate
4313
4314 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4315 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4316 that's a bit more complex:
4317
4318 @example
4319 clock speed 8 kHz
4320 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4321 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4322 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4323 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4324 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4325 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4326 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4327 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4328 @end example
4329
4330 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4331 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4332 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4333 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4334 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4335 and so forth.
4336
4337 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4338 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4339 @cindex DAP declaration
4340
4341 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4342 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4343 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4344 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4345 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4346
4347 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4348
4349 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4350 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4351 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4352 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4353 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4354
4355 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4356
4357 @itemize @bullet
4358 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4359 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4360 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4361 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4362 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4363
4364 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4365 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4366 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4367 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4368 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4369 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4370
4371 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4372 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4373 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4374 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4375 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4376 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4377 @end itemize
4378 @end deffn
4379
4380 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4381 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4382 for TCL scripting.
4383 @end deffn
4384
4385 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4386 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4387 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4388 @end deffn
4389
4390 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4391 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4392 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4393 initialization, too.
4394 @end deffn
4395
4396 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4397
4398 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4399 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4400 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4401 @end deffn
4402
4403 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4404 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4405 @end deffn
4406
4407 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4408 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4409 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4410 or set a new value @var{value}.
4411 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4412 @end deffn
4413
4414 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4415 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4419 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4420 value @var{value}.
4421
4422 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4423 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4424 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4425
4426 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4427 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4428 @end deffn
4429
4430 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4431 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4432 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4433 @end deffn
4434
4435 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4436 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4437 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4438 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4439 @end deffn
4440
4441 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4442 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4443
4444 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4445 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4446 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4447 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4448 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4449 for details.
4450
4451 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4452 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4453 the pattern:
4454 @example
4455 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4456 @end example
4457
4458 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4459 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4460 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4461 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4462 @example
4463 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4464 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4465 @end example
4466
4467 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4468 @example
4469 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4470 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4471 @end example
4472
4473 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4474 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4475
4476 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4477 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4478 example with a proper dap name:
4479 @example
4480 xxx.dap apcsw default
4481 @end example
4482 @end deffn
4483
4484 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4485 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4486 Disabled by default
4487 @end deffn
4488
4489
4490 @node CPU Configuration
4491 @chapter CPU Configuration
4492 @cindex GDB target
4493
4494 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4495 You can also access these targets without GDB
4496 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4497 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4498 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4499 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4500
4501 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4502 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4503
4504 @section Target List
4505 @cindex target, current
4506 @cindex target, list
4507
4508 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4509 where each member has a name.
4510 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4511 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4512 (plural!) command.
4513 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4514 look like with more than one:
4515 @verbatim
4516 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4517 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4518 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4519 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4520 @end verbatim
4521
4522 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4523 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4524 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4525 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4526 space seen by that current target.
4527 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4528 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4529 are examples; and there are many more.
4530
4531 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4532
4533 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4534 Returns the name of the current target.
4535 @end deffn
4536
4537 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4538 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4539 @example
4540 foreach t [target names] @{
4541 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4542 @}
4543 @end example
4544 @end deffn
4545
4546 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4547 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4548
4549 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4550 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4551 command names are singular.}
4552
4553 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4554 targets in a user friendly form.
4555
4556 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4557 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4558 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4559 @end deffn
4560
4561 @section Target CPU Types
4562 @cindex target type
4563 @cindex CPU type
4564
4565 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4566 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4567 when calling @command{target create}.
4568 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4569 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4570 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4571 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4572 what core-specific commands may be available
4573 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4574 and more.
4575
4576 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4577 since there's a command to list them.
4578
4579 @anchor{targettypes}
4580 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4581 Lists all supported target types.
4582 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4583
4584 @itemize @bullet
4585 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4586 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4587 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4588 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4589 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4590 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4591 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4592 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4593 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4594 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4595 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4596 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4597 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4598 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4599 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4600 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4601 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4602 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4603 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4604 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4605 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4606 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4607 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4608 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4609 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4610 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4611 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4612 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4613 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4614 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4615 support for new CPUs.
4616 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4617 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4618 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4619 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4620 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4621 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4622 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4623 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4624 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4625 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4626 @itemize @minus
4627 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4628 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4629 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4630 @end itemize
4631 And two debug interfaces cores:
4632 @itemize @minus
4633 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4634 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4635 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4636 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4637 @end itemize
4638 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4639 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4640 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4641 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4642 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4643 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4644 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4645 @end itemize
4646 @end deffn
4647
4648 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4649 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4650 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4651 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4652 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4653 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4654 reflect design generations;
4655 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4656 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4657
4658 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4659 @section Target Configuration
4660
4661 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4662 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4663 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4664 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4665 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4666
4667 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4668 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4669 optional parts.
4670 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4671 command, created as part of target creation.
4672
4673 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4674 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4675 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4676 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4677 to be much more board-specific.
4678 The key steps you use might look something like this
4679
4680 @example
4681 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4682 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4683 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4684 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4685 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4686 @end example
4687
4688 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4689 on-chip SRAM.
4690 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4691 writes to target memory;
4692 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4693 GDB memory checksumming;
4694 and more.
4695
4696 @quotation Warning
4697 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4698 inaccessible when application code
4699 (such as an operating system)
4700 enables or disables the MMU.
4701 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4702 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4703 easy access to other addresses needed.
4704 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4705 @end quotation
4706
4707 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4708 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4709 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4710 controllers.
4711 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4712 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4713 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4714
4715 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4716 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4717 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4718 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4719 purposes including additional configuration.
4720
4721 @itemize @bullet
4722 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4723 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4724 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4725 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4726
4727 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4728 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4729 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4730 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4731 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4732 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4733 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4734
4735 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4736 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4737 @end itemize
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4741 The options accepted by this command may also be
4742 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4743 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4744 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4745
4746 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4747 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4748 and changing its endianness.
4749
4750 @itemize @bullet
4751
4752 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4753 used to access this target.
4754
4755 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4756 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4757 create and manage DAP instances.
4758
4759 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4760 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4761
4762 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4763 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4764 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4765 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4766 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4767 same event name assigns only one handler.
4768
4769 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4770 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4771
4772 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4773 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4774 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4775 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4776 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4777 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4778 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4779
4780 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4781 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4782 or virtual address is being used.
4783
4784 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4785 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4786
4787 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4788 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4789 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4790 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4791 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4792
4793 @anchor{rtostype}
4794 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4795 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4796 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4797 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4798 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4799 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4800
4801 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4802 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4803 access the target for debugging.
4804
4805 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4806 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4807 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4808 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4809
4810 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4811 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4812 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4813 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4814 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4815
4816 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4817 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4818 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4819 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4820 command @command{gdb_port}.
4821 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4822
4823 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4824 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4825 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4826 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4827 @end itemize
4828 @end deffn
4829
4830 @section Other $target_name Commands
4831 @cindex object command
4832
4833 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4834 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4835
4836 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4837 Once a button is created a button
4838 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4839 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4840 configure it like this:
4841
4842 @example
4843 # Create
4844 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4845 # Modify
4846 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4847 # Query
4848 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4849 # Report
4850 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4851 @end example
4852
4853 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4854 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4855
4856 @example
4857 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4858 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4859 @end example
4860
4861 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4862
4863 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4864 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4865 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4866 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4867 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4868 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4869 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4870 They are not otherwise documented here.
4871 @end deffn
4872
4873 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4874 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4875 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4876 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4877 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4878 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4879 the target side uses raw memory.
4880
4881 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4882 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4883 The script orientation comes from working with data
4884 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4885 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4886 and neither store nor return those values.
4887
4888 @itemize
4889 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4890 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4891 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4892 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4893 @end itemize
4894 @end deffn
4895
4896 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4897 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4898 @command{$target_name configure}
4899 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4900 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4901 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4902 There are a few special cases:
4903
4904 @itemize @bullet
4905 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4906 event named @var{event_name}.
4907 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4908 two parameters.
4909 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4910 This is a special case because this is set using
4911 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4912 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4913 @end itemize
4914
4915 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4916 all the targets you might use something like this:
4917
4918 @example
4919 foreach name [target names] @{
4920 set y [$name cget -endian]
4921 set z [$name cget -type]
4922 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4923 $x $name $y $z]
4924 @}
4925 @end example
4926 @end deffn
4927
4928 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4929 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4930 Displays the current target state:
4931 @code{debug-running},
4932 @code{halted},
4933 @code{reset},
4934 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4935 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4939 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4940 currently associated with this target.
4941 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4942 @end deffn
4943
4944 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4945 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4946 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4947 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4948 @end deffn
4949
4950 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4951 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4952 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4953 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4954 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4955 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4956 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4957 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4958 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4959 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4960 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4961 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4962 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4963 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4964 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4965 @end deffn
4966
4967 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4968 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4969 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4970 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4971 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4972 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4973 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4974 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4975 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4976 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4977 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4978 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4979 @end deffn
4980
4981 @anchor{targetevents}
4982 @section Target Events
4983 @cindex target events
4984 @cindex events
4985 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4986 For example:
4987 @itemize @bullet
4988 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4989 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4990 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4991 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4992 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4993 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4994 to set up system clocks or
4995 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4996 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4997 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4998 @end itemize
4999
5000 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5001 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5002 @command{target create ... -event}.
5003
5004 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5005 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5006 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5007
5008 @example
5009 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5010 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5011 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5012 @}
5013 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5014 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5015 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5016 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5017 @}
5018 @end example
5019
5020 The following target events are defined:
5021
5022 @itemize @bullet
5023 @item @b{debug-halted}
5024 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5025 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5026 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5027 @item @b{early-halted}
5028 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5029 @item @b{examine-start}
5030 @* Before target examine is called.
5031 @item @b{examine-end}
5032 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5033 @item @b{examine-fail}
5034 @* After target examine fails.
5035 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5036 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5037 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5038 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5039 connect GDB to running target.
5040 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5041 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5042 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5043 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5044 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5045 is in RAM or read only memory.
5046 Default is @code{halt}
5047 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5048 @* When GDB disconnects
5049 @item @b{gdb-end}
5050 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5051 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5052 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5053 @code{reset init})
5054 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5055 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5056 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5057 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5058 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5059 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5060 @item @b{gdb-start}
5061 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5062 @item @b{halted}
5063 @* The target has halted
5064 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5065 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5066 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5067 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5068 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5069 @item @b{reset-assert}
5070 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5071 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5072 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5073 it instead of asserting SRST.
5074 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5075 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5076 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5077 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5078 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5079 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5080 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5081 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5082 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5083 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5084 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5085 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5086 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5087 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5088 released on the scan chain.
5089 @item @b{reset-end}
5090 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5091 @item @b{reset-init}
5092 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5093 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5094
5095 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5096 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5097 multiplexing, and so on.
5098 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5099 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5100 @item @b{reset-start}
5101 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5102 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5103
5104 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5105 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5106 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5107 @item @b{resume-start}
5108 @* Before any target is resumed
5109 @item @b{resume-end}
5110 @* After all targets have resumed
5111 @item @b{resumed}
5112 @* Target has resumed
5113 @item @b{step-start}
5114 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5115 @item @b{step-end}
5116 @* After single-step has completed
5117 @item @b{trace-config}
5118 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5119 @end itemize
5120
5121 @quotation Note
5122 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5123 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5124 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5125 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5126 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5127 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5128 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5129 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5130 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5131 check if the core has changed status.
5132 @end quotation
5133
5134 @node Flash Commands
5135 @chapter Flash Commands
5136
5137 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5138 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5139 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5140 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5141 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5142 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5143 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5144 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5145 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5146
5147 Flash Steps:
5148 @enumerate
5149 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5150 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5151 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5152 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5153 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5154 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5155 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5156 @item GDB Flashing
5157 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5158 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5159 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5160 @end enumerate
5161
5162 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5163 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5164 so that it can't boot.
5165 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5166 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5167
5168 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5169 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5170 @cindex flash configuration
5171
5172 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5173 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5174 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5175 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5176 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5177 see the driver-specific documentation.
5178
5179 @itemize @bullet
5180 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5181 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5182 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5183 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5184 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5185 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5186 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5187 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5188 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5189 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5190 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5191 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5192 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5193 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5194 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5195 commands to the flash controller.
5196 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5197 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5198 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5199 for more information.
5200 @end itemize
5201 @quotation Note
5202 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5203 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5204 @end quotation
5205 @end deffn
5206
5207 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5208 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5209 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5210 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5211 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5212 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5216 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5217 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5218 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5219 @end deffn
5220
5221 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5222 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5223 depends on the flash type.
5224 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5225 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5226 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5227 but most don't bother.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5231
5232 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5233 begins.
5234
5235 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5236 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5237 until the programming session is finished.
5238
5239 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5240 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5241
5242 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5243
5244 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5245 @cindex flash erasing
5246 @cindex flash reading
5247 @cindex flash writing
5248 @cindex flash programming
5249 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5250
5251 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5252 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5253 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5254 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5255 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5256
5257 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5258 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5259 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5260 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5261 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5262
5263 @quotation Note
5264 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5265 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5266 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5267 back to a flash bank.
5268 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5269 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5270 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5271 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5272 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5273 @end quotation
5274
5275 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5276 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5277 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5278 disabled first.
5279 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5280 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5281 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5282
5283 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5284 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5285 up to and including @var{last}.
5286 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5287 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5288 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5289 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5293 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5294 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5295 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5296 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5297 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5298 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5299 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5300 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5301 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5302 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5303 before erase starts.
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5307 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5308 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5309 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5310 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5311 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5312 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5313 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5314 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5315 before issuing this command.
5316 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5317 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5318 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5319 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5320 @end deffn
5321 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5322
5323 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5324 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5325 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5326 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5327 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5328 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5329 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5330 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5331 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5332 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5333 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5334 @end deffn
5335
5336 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5337 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5338 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5339 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5340 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5344 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5345 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5346 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5347 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5348 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5352 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5353 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5354 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5359 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5360 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5361 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5362 to the base address for each section in the image.
5363 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5364 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5365 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5366 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5367 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5368 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5369 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5370 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5371 each image section.
5372
5373 @quotation Warning
5374 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5375 data you want to preserve.
5376 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5377 sections might be erased with no notice.
5378 @itemize
5379 @item
5380 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5381 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5382 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5383 @item
5384 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5385 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5386 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5387 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5388 @end itemize
5389 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5390 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5391 @end quotation
5392
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5396 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5397 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5398 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5399 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5400 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5401 ordinary memory reads.
5402 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5403 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5404 check for successful programming.
5405 @end deffn
5406
5407 @section Other Flash commands
5408 @cindex flash protection
5409
5410 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5411 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5412 and display that status.
5413 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5414 @end deffn
5415
5416 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5417 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5418 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5419
5420 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5421 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5422 and possibly stale information.
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @anchor{flashprotect}
5426 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5427 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5428 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5429 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5430 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5431 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5432 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5433 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5434 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5435 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5436 @end deffn
5437
5438 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5439 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5440 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5441 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @anchor{program}
5445 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5446 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5447 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5448 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5449 @end deffn
5450
5451 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5452 @section Flash Driver List
5453 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5454 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5455 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5456
5457 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5458 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5459 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5460
5461 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5462
5463 @itemize
5464 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5465 @end itemize
5466
5467 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5468 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5469 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5470 @example
5471 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5472 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5473 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5474 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5475 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5476 @end example
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @subsection External Flash
5480
5481 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5482 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5483 @cindex CFI
5484 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5485 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5486 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5487 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5488 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5489 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5490 configure a bus and its timings), or
5491 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5492 on the flash chip.
5493 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5494 speed up operation.
5495
5496 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5497
5498 @itemize
5499 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5500 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5501 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5502 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5503 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5504 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5505 @end itemize
5506
5507 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5508 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5509
5510 @example
5511 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5512 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5513 @end example
5514
5515 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5516 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5517 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5518
5519 @example
5520 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5521 @end example
5522
5523 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5524 @end deffn
5525
5526 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5527 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5528 @cindex SPI
5529 @cindex jtagspi
5530 @cindex bscan_spi
5531 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5532 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5533 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5534 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5535 accessed through JTAG.
5536
5537 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5538 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5539 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5540 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5541 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5542 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5543
5544 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5545 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5546 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5547 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5548 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5549 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5550 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5551 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5552
5553 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5554 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5555 command, see below.
5556
5557 @itemize
5558 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5559 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5560 @var{USER1} instruction.
5561 @end itemize
5562
5563 @example
5564 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5565 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5566 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5567 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5568 @end example
5569
5570 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5571 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5572 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5573 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5574 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5575 @example
5576 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5577 @end example
5578 @end deffn
5579
5580 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5581 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5582 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5583 @example
5584 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5585 @end example
5586 @end deffn
5587
5588 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5589 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5590 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5591 @end deffn
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5595 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5596 @cindex xcf
5597 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5598 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5599 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5600 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5601 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5602
5603 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5604 command accepts additional parameters:
5605 @itemize
5606 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5607 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5608 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5609 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5610 in master mode.
5611 @end itemize
5612 @example
5613 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5614 @end example
5615 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5616 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5617 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5618 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5619 dedicated sector.
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5623 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5624 button.
5625 @example
5626 xcf configure 0
5627 @end example
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 Additional driver notes:
5631 @itemize
5632 @item Only single revision supported.
5633 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5634 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5635 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5636 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5637 @end itemize
5638 @end deffn
5639
5640 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5641 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5642 @cindex SPIFI
5643 @cindex lpcspifi
5644 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5645 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5646 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5647
5648 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5649 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5650 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5651 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5652 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5653
5654 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5655 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5656 are configured by the driver.
5657
5658 @example
5659 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5660 @end example
5661
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5665 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5666 @cindex SMI
5667 @cindex stmsmi
5668 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5669 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5670 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5671 SPI flash devices.
5672 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5673 flash devices can be connected.
5674
5675 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5676 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5677 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5678 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5679 the flash content.
5680
5681 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5682 to identify the memory bank.
5683 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5684 flash size, are detected automatically.
5685
5686 @example
5687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5688 @end example
5689
5690 @end deffn
5691
5692 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5693 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5694 @cindex QuadSPI
5695 @cindex OctoSPI
5696 @cindex stmqspi
5697 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5698 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5699 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5700 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5701 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5702 mode is not.
5703
5704 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5705 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5706 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5707 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5708
5709 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5710 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5711 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5712
5713 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5714 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5715 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5716 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5717 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5718 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5719
5720 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5721 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5722 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5723 should be avoided.
5724
5725 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5726 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5727 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5728 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5729 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5730 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5731
5732 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5733 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5734 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5735 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5736 persist across openocd invocations.
5737
5738 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5739 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5740 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5741 required (see 'set' command).
5742
5743 @example
5744 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5745 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5747 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5748 @end example
5749
5750 There are three specific commands
5751 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5752 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5753 chip specific write protection engaged.
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5757 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5758 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5759 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5760 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5761 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5762
5763 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5764 which don't support an id command.
5765
5766 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5767 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5768 @end deffn
5769
5770 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5771 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5772 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5773 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5774 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5775
5776 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5777 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5778 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5779 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5780
5781 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5782
5783 To check basic communication settings, issue
5784 @example
5785 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5786 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5787 @end example
5788 for single flash mode or
5789 @example
5790 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5791 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5792 @end example
5793 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5794
5795 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5796 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5797 need a dummy address, e.g.
5798 @example
5799 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5800 @end example
5801 should return the status register contents.
5802
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @end deffn
5806
5807 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5808 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5809 Microcontroller platform.
5810
5811 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5812 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5813
5814 @example
5815 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5816 @end example
5817
5818 @end deffn
5819
5820 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5821 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5822 @cindex ath79
5823 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5824 chip selects.
5825 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5826 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5827 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5828 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5829 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5830 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5831
5832 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5833 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5834 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5835 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5836 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5837 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5838 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5839 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5840 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5841 with the default CS0.
5842 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5843 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5844 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5845
5846 @example
5847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5848
5849 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5850 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5851 # distinguish the banks.
5852 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5853 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5854 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5855 @end example
5856
5857 @end deffn
5858
5859 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5860 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5861 @cindex fespi
5862
5863 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5864
5865 @example
5866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5867 @end example
5868 @end deffn
5869
5870 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5871
5872 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5873 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5874 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5875 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5876 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5877 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5878
5879 @example
5880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5881 @end example
5882 @end deffn
5883
5884 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5885 @cindex ambiqmicro
5886 @cindex apollo
5887 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5888 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5889 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5890 with the target using SWD.
5891
5892 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5893 the device class of the MCU.
5894 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5895 to set up the flash banks.
5896 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5897 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5898
5899 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5900 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5901 and the second bank starts after the first.
5902
5903 @example
5904 # Flash bank 0
5905 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5906 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5908 $_TARGETNAME
5909 @end example
5910
5911 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5912 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5913 are available to the user.
5914
5915 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5916
5917 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5918 Erase entire bank.
5919 @end deffn
5920 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5921 Erase device pages.
5922 @end deffn
5923 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5924 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5925 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5926 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5927 the flash.
5928 @end deffn
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @anchor{at91samd}
5932 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5933 @cindex at91samd
5934 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5935 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5936
5937 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5938
5939 The devices have one flash bank:
5940
5941 @example
5942 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5943 @end example
5944
5945 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5946 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5947 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5948 processor to be halted.
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5952 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5953 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5954 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5955 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5956 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5957
5958 @example
5959 at91samd set-security enable
5960 @end example
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5964 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5965 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5966 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5967 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5968 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5969 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5970 in order to disable this feature.
5971
5972 @example
5973 at91samd eeprom
5974 at91samd eeprom 1024
5975 @end example
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5979 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5980 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5981 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5982 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5983 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5984
5985 @example
5986 at91samd bootloader
5987 at91samd bootloader 16384
5988 @end example
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5992 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5993 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5994 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5995 @end deffn
5996
5997 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5998 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5999 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6000 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6001 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6002 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6003 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6004 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6005
6006 @example
6007 # Read user row
6008 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6009 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6010 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6011 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6012 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6013 # byte unchanged
6014 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6015 @end example
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @end deffn
6019
6020 @anchor{at91sam3}
6021 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6022 @cindex at91sam3
6023 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6024 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6025 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6026 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6027 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6028 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6029 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6030 chips are confirmed.}
6031
6032 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6033 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6034 the following fixed locations:
6035
6036 @example
6037 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6038 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6039 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6040 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6041 @end example
6042
6043 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6044 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6045 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6046
6047 @itemize
6048 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6049 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6050 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6051 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6052 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6053 @end itemize
6054
6055 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6056
6057 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6058 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6059 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6060 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6061 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6062 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6063 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6064
6065 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6066 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6067 @end deffn
6068
6069 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6070 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6071 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6072 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6073 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6074 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6075 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6076 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6080 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6081 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6082 @end deffn
6083 @end deffn
6084
6085 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6086 @cindex at91sam4
6087 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6088 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6089 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6093 @cindex at91sam4l
6094 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6095 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6096 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6097
6098 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6099 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6100 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6101 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6102 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6103 @end deffn
6104 @end deffn
6105
6106 @anchor{atsame5}
6107 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6108 @cindex atsame5
6109 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6110 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6111 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6112
6113 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6114 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6115 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6116
6117 @example
6118 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6119 @end example
6120
6121 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6122 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6123 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6124 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6125 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6126 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6127
6128 @example
6129 atsame5 bootloader
6130 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6131 @end example
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6135 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6136 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6137 processor to be halted.
6138 @end deffn
6139
6140 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6141 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6142 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6143 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6144 @end deffn
6145
6146 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6147 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6148 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6149 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6150 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6151 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6152 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6153 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6154
6155 @example
6156 # Read
6157 >atsame5 userpage
6158 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6159 # Write
6160 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6161 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6162 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6163 # bytes)
6164 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6165 @end example
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6171 @cindex atsamv
6172 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6173 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6174 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6178 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6179 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6180 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6181 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6182
6183 @example
6184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6185 @end example
6186
6187 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6188 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6189
6190 @itemize
6191 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6192 @item @var{banks}
6193 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6194 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6195 @item @var{pages_size}
6196 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6197 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6198 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6199 @end itemize
6200
6201 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6202 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6203 will be autoconfigured.
6204 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6205
6206 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6207 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6208 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6209 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6210 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6211
6212 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6213 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6214 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6215 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6216 are not truly general purpose).
6217 @quotation Note
6218 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6219 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6220 @end quotation
6221 @end deffn
6222 @end deffn
6223
6224 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6225 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6226 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6227 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6228 @end deffn
6229
6230 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6231 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6232 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6233 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6234
6235 @example
6236 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6237 @end example
6238
6239 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6240 each single sector one by one.
6241
6242 @example
6243 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6244 @end example
6245
6246 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6247 @end deffn
6248
6249 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6250 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6251 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6252 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6253 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6254 starts at address 0.
6255
6256 @example
6257 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6258 @end example
6259 @end deffn
6260
6261 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6262 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6263 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6264 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6265 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6266 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6267 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6268 and programming the serial flash.
6269
6270 @example
6271 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6272 @end example
6273 @end deffn
6274
6275 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6276 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6277 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6278 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6279 autoconfigures itself.
6280 @example
6281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6282 @end example
6283 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6284 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6285 this via the following command:
6286 @example
6287 efm32 debuglock num
6288 @end example
6289 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6290 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6291 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6292 supported.}
6293 @end deffn
6294
6295 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6296 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6297 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6298 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6299 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6300 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6301
6302 @example
6303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6304 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6305 @end example
6306
6307 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6308 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6312 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6313 is an uncommon operation.}
6314 @end deffn
6315 @end deffn
6316
6317 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6318 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6319 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6320 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6321 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6322 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6323 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6324
6325 @example
6326 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6327 @end example
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6331 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6332 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6333 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6334 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6335 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6336 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6337 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6338 characters) ignored.
6339
6340 @example
6341 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6342 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6343 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6344 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6345 @end example
6346 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6347 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6351 @cindex kinetis
6352 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6353 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6354 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6355 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6356 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6357 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6358
6359 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6360 @itemize
6361 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6362 @end itemize
6363
6364 @example
6365 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6366 @end example
6367
6368 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6369 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6370 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6371 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6375 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6376 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6377 set by 'flash protect' command.
6378 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6379 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6380 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6381 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6382 with the rest of a flash image.
6383 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6387 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6388 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6389 @end deffn
6390
6391 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6392 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6393 and examine-fail event.
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6397 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6398 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6399 @end deffn
6400
6401 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6402 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6403 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6404 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6405 command completes.
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6409 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6410 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6411 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6412 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6413
6414 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6415 Program Partition command.
6416
6417 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6418 Reset the device after partition setting.
6419
6420 Show partition size:
6421 @example
6422 kinetis nvm_partition info
6423 @end example
6424
6425 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6426 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6427 @example
6428 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6429 @end example
6430
6431 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6432 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6433 @example
6434 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6435 @end example
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6439 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6440 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6444 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6445 Command disables watchdog timer.
6446 @end deffn
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6450 @cindex kinetis_ke
6451 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6452 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6453 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6454 autoconfigures itself.
6455 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6456
6457 @example
6458 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6459 @end example
6460
6461 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6462 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6463 @end deffn
6464
6465 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6466 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6467 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6468 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6469 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6473 Command disables watchdog timer.
6474 @end deffn
6475 @end deffn
6476
6477 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6478 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6479 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6480 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6481 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6482
6483 @quotation Note
6484 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6485 driver:
6486 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6487 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6488 @end quotation
6489
6490 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6491 which must appear in the following order:
6492
6493 @itemize
6494 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6495 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6496 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6497 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6498 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6499 LPC43x[2357])
6500 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6501 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6502 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6503 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6504 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6505 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6506 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6507 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6508 at which the core is running
6509 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6510 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6511 @quotation Note
6512 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6513 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6514 However, if you do provide it,
6515 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6516 @end quotation
6517 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6518 ROM IAP entry point.
6519 @end itemize
6520
6521 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6522
6523 @example
6524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6525 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6526 @end example
6527
6528 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6529 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6530 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6531 @end deffn
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6535 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6536 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6537 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6538 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6539 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6540
6541 @example
6542 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6543 @end example
6544 @end deffn
6545
6546 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6547 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6548 from NXP.
6549
6550 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6551 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6552 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6553 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6554 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6555 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6556 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6557 you start the PLL.
6558
6559 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6560
6561 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6562 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6563 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6564
6565 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6566 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6567 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6568 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6569 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6570 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6571 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6572
6573 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6574 @example
6575 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6576 @end example
6577
6578 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6579 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6580 @code{flash banks} command.
6581
6582 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6583 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6584 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6585 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6586 a known signature.
6587 Example:
6588 @example
6589 lpc2900 signature 0
6590 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6591 @end example
6592 @end deffn
6593
6594 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6595 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6596 saves it to a file in binary format.
6597 Example:
6598 @example
6599 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6600 @end example
6601 @end deffn
6602
6603 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6604 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6605 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6606 command:
6607
6608 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6609 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6610 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6611 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6612
6613 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6614 Example:
6615 @example
6616 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6617 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6618 @end example
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6622 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6623 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6624 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6625 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6626 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6627 912 bytes.
6628 @quotation Attention
6629 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6630 @end quotation
6631 Example:
6632 @example
6633 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6634 @end example
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6638 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6639 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6640 after the next power cycle.
6641 @quotation Attention
6642 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6643 @end quotation
6644 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6645 Example:
6646 @example
6647 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6648 flash info 0
6649 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6650 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6651 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6652 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6653 @end example
6654 @end deffn
6655
6656 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6657 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6658 effective after the next power cycle.
6659 @quotation Attention
6660 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6661 @end quotation
6662 Examples:
6663 @example
6664 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6665 @end example
6666 @end deffn
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6670 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6671 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6672 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6673
6674 @example
6675 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6676 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6677 @end example
6678
6679 @itemize @bullet
6680 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6681 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6682 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6683 @end itemize
6684
6685 Example usage:
6686 @example
6687 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6688 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6689 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6690 @} else @{
6691 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6692 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6693 @}
6694 @end example
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6698 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6699 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6700 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6701 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6702 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6703
6704 @example
6705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6706 @end example
6707
6708 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6709 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6710 only the main program flash.
6711
6712 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6713 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6714 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6715 @end deffn
6716
6717 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6718 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6719 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6720 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6721
6722 To erase and program the BSL:
6723 @example
6724 msp432 bsl unlock
6725 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6726 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6727 msp432 bsl lock
6728 @end example
6729 @end deffn
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6733 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6734 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6735 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6736 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6737 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6738 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6739 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6740 also have division into regions: main and info.
6741 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6742 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6743
6744 @example
6745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6746 @end example
6747
6748 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6749
6750 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6751 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6755 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6759 Erase all userflash including info region.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6763 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6767 Check sectors protect.
6768 @end deffn
6769
6770 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6771 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6775 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6779 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6780 @end deffn
6781
6782 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6783 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6787 Show information about flash driver.
6788 @end deffn
6789
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6793 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6794 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6795 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6796 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6797
6798 @example
6799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6800 @end example
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6804 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6805 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6806 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6807 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6808
6809 @example
6810 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6811 @end example
6812
6813 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6814
6815 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6816 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6817 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6818 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6819 code.
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6823 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6829 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6830 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6831
6832 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6833 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6834 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6835 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6836
6837 @example
6838 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6839 @end example
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6843 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6844 and integrate flash memory.
6845
6846 @example
6847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6849 @end example
6850
6851 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6852 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6853 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6854 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6855 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6856 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6857 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6858 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6859 @end deffn
6860 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6861 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6862 This will remove any Code Protection.
6863 @end deffn
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6867 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6868 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6869 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6870 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6871
6872 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6873 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6874
6875 @example
6876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6877 @end example
6878
6879 psoc4-specific commands
6880 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6881 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6882
6883 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6884 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6885
6886 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6887 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6888 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6889
6890 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6891 @end deffn
6892
6893 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6894 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6895
6896 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6897 @end deffn
6898 @end deffn
6899
6900 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6901 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6902 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6903 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6904 apart from the base address.
6905
6906 @example
6907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6908 @end example
6909
6910 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6911 @quotation Attention
6912 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6913 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6914 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6915 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6916 @end quotation
6917
6918 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6919
6920 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6921 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6922 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6923 @end deffn
6924 @end deffn
6925
6926 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6927 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6928 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6929 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6930 apart from the base address.
6931
6932 @example
6933 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6934 $_TARGETNAME
6935 @end example
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6939 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6940 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6941 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6942
6943 @example
6944 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6945 @end example
6946
6947 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6948
6949 @itemize
6950 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6951 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6952 @end itemize
6953
6954 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6955
6956 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6957 @quotation Attention
6958 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6959 after successful write.
6960 @end quotation
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6964 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6965 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6966 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6967
6968 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6969 @itemize @bullet
6970 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6971 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6972 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6973 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6974 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6975 row size: 512 bytes.
6976 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6977 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6978 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6979 operation will erase row automatically.
6980 @end itemize
6981
6982 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6983 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6984
6985 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6986
6987 @example
6988 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6989 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6990 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6991 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6992 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6993 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6994 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6995 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6996 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6997 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6998 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6999 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7000
7001 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7002 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7003 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7004 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7005 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7006 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7007 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7008 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7009 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7010 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7011 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7012 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7013 @end example
7014
7015 psoc6-specific commands
7016 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7017 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7018 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7019 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7020 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7021 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7025 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7026 by @command{flash banks}.
7027 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7028 @end deffn
7029 @end deffn
7030
7031 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7032 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7033 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7034 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7035 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7036
7037 @example
7038 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7039 @end example
7040 @end deffn
7041
7042 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7043 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7044 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7045 and SWD interface.
7046 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7047 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7048
7049 @example
7050 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7051 @end example
7052
7053 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7054
7055 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7056 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7057 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7061 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7062 @end deffn
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7066 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7067 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7068 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7069 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7070
7071 @example
7072 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7073 @end example
7074
7075 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7076 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7077 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7078 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7079 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7080 disabled.
7081
7082 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7083 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7084 @quotation Warning
7085 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7086 applied to all of them.
7087 @end quotation
7088 @end deffn
7089 @end deffn
7090
7091 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7092 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7093 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7094 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7095 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7096 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7097
7098 @example
7099 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7100 @end example
7101
7102 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7103 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7104 the flash driver.
7105
7106 @example
7107 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7108 @end example
7109
7110 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7111 as per the following example.
7112 @example
7113 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7114 @end example
7115
7116 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7117
7118 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7119 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7120 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7124 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7125 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7126 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7130 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7131 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7132 @end deffn
7133
7134 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7135 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7136 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7137 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7138 @end deffn
7139
7140 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7141 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7142 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7143 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7147 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7148 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7149 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7150 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7151 @end deffn
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7155 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7156 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7157 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7158 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7159
7160 @example
7161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7162 @end example
7163
7164 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7165 as per the following example.
7166 @example
7167 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7168 @end example
7169
7170 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7171 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7173 @end deffn
7174
7175 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7176 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7177 the flash driver.
7178
7179 @example
7180 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7181 @end example
7182
7183 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7184
7185 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7186 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7187 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7191 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7192 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7193 @end deffn
7194
7195 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7196 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7197 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7201 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7202 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7203 @end deffn
7204
7205 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7206 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7207 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7208 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7209 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7210 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7214 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7215 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7216 @end deffn
7217 @end deffn
7218
7219 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7220 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7221 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7222 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7223 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7224
7225 @example
7226 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7227 @end example
7228
7229 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7230 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7231 the flash driver.
7232
7233 @example
7234 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7235 @end example
7236
7237 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7238
7239 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7240 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7241 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7245 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7246 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7250 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7251 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7252 @end deffn
7253
7254 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7255 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7256 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7257 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7258 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7259
7260 Example usage:
7261 @example
7262 # read OPTSR_CUR
7263 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7264 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7265 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7266 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7267 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7268 @end example
7269 @end deffn
7270
7271 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7272 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7273 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7274 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7275 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7276 will be touched).
7277
7278 Example usage:
7279 @example
7280 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7281 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7282 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7283 @end example
7284 @end deffn
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7288 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7289 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7290 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7291 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7292
7293 @example
7294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7295 @end example
7296
7297 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7298 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7299 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7300 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7301 second bank.
7302
7303 @example
7304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7305 @end example
7306
7307 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7308
7309 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7310 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7311 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7315 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7316 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7320 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7321 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7322 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7323 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7324 @end deffn
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7328 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7329 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7330 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7331 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7332 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7333
7334 @example
7335 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7336 @end example
7337
7338 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7339 as per the following example.
7340 @example
7341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7342 @end example
7343
7344 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7345 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7346 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7350 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7351 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7352 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7353
7354 @example
7355 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7356 @end example
7357
7358 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7359
7360 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7361 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7362 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7363
7364 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7365 @end deffn
7366
7367 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7368 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7369 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7370
7371 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7372 @end deffn
7373
7374 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7375 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7376 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7380 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7381 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7382 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7383
7384 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7385 @example
7386 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7387 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7388 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7389 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7390 @end example
7391
7392 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7393 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7397 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7398 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7399 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7400 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7401
7402 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7403
7404 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7405 @example
7406 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7407 @end example
7408
7409 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7410 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7411 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7415 List the protected areas using WRP.
7416 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7417 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7418 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7419
7420 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7421 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7422 in single or dual-banks mode.
7423 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7424 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7425
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7429 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7430 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7431 @end deffn
7432
7433 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7434 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7435 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7436 the TrustZone status.
7437 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7438 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7439 @end deffn
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7443 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7444 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7445 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7446 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7447
7448 @example
7449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7450 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7451 @end example
7452
7453 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7454 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7455 for the specified flash bank.
7456 @end deffn
7457 @end deffn
7458
7459 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7460 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7461 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7462 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7463 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7464
7465 @example
7466 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7467 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7468 @end example
7469
7470 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7471 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7472 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7473
7474 @itemize @bullet
7475 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7476 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7477 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7478 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7479 @end itemize
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7485 @cindex str9xpec
7486
7487 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7488 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7489 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7490 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7491
7492 Here is some background info to help
7493 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7494 the str9:
7495 @enumerate
7496 @item
7497 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7498 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7499 @item
7500 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7501 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7502 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7503 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7504 @end enumerate
7505
7506 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7507 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7508 configured for flash bank 0.
7509 @example
7510 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7511 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7512 adapter assert srst
7513 # turn off target polling
7514 poll off
7515 # disable str9 core
7516 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7517 # read option bytes
7518 str9xpec options_read 0
7519 # re-enable str9 core
7520 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7521 poll on
7522 reset halt
7523 @end example
7524 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7525 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7526 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7527 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7528
7529 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7530
7531 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7532 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7536 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7537 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7538 @end deffn
7539
7540 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7541 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7542 erase the device.
7543 @end deffn
7544
7545 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7546 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7547 @end deffn
7548
7549 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7550 Configure str9 boot bank.
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7554 Configure str9 lvd source.
7555 @end deffn
7556
7557 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7558 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7559 @end deffn
7560
7561 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7562 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7563 @end deffn
7564
7565 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7566 Read str9 option bytes.
7567 @end deffn
7568
7569 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7570 Write str9 option bytes.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7574 unlock str9 device.
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7580 @cindex swm050
7581 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7582
7583 @example
7584 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7585 @end example
7586
7587 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7588
7589 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7590 Erases the entire flash bank.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @end deffn
7594
7595
7596 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7597 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7598 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7599 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7600
7601 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7602
7603 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7604 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7608 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7609 @end deffn
7610
7611 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7612 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7613 the flash clock.
7614 @end deffn
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7618 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7619 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7620 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7621 correct bank config.
7622
7623 @example
7624 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7625 @end example
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7629 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7630 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7634 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7635 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7636
7637 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7638
7639 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7640 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7644 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7645 @end deffn
7646
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @section NAND Flash Commands
7650 @cindex NAND
7651
7652 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7653 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7654 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7655
7656 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7657 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7658 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7659 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7660 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7661 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7662
7663 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7664 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7665 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7666 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7667 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7668 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7669 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7670 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7671 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7672 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7673
7674 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7675 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7676 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7677 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7678 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7679 every 512 bytes of data.
7680
7681 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7682 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7683 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7684 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7685 ECC mode is used.
7686
7687 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7688 @enumerate
7689 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7690 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7691 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7692 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7693 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7694 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7695 to access that device.
7696 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7697 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7698 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7699 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7700 de-brick a board.
7701 @end enumerate
7702
7703 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7704 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7705 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7706 are only 32 bits wide.
7707 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7708 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7709 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7710 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7711
7712 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7713 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7714 @cindex NAND configuration
7715
7716 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7717 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7718 OpenOCD has initialized.
7719
7720 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7721 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7722 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7723 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7724 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7725 they were a single (larger) device.
7726 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7727 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7728
7729 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7730 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7731 configuration files, not interactively.
7732
7733 @itemize @bullet
7734 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7735 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7736 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7737 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7738 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7739 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7740 commands to the NAND controller.
7741 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7742 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7743 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7744 for more information.
7745 @end itemize
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7749 Prints a summary of each device declared
7750 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7751 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7752 @example
7753 > nand list
7754 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7755 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7756 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7757 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7758 >
7759 @end example
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7763 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7764 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7765 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7766 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7767 it with most other NAND commands.
7768 @end deffn
7769
7770 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7771
7772 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7773 @cindex NAND reading
7774 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7775 starting at the specified offset.
7776 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7777
7778 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7779 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7780
7781 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7782 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7783 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7784
7785 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7786 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7787 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7788 method which handled that error correction.
7789
7790 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7791 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7792 @itemize @bullet
7793 @item no oob_* parameter
7794 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7795 @item @code{oob_raw}
7796 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7797 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7798 spare areas associated with each data page.
7799 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7800 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7801 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7802 @item @code{oob_only}
7803 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7804 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7805 spare areas associated with each data page.
7806 @end itemize
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7810 @cindex NAND erasing
7811 @cindex NAND programming
7812 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7813 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7814 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7815 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7816 If those parameters are not specified,
7817 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7818 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7819
7820 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7821 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7822 block marker.
7823 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7824 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7828 @cindex NAND writing
7829 @cindex NAND programming
7830 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7831 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7832 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7833 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7834
7835 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7836 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7837
7838 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7839 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7840 past the end of the device.
7841 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7842 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7843 if that's being written.)
7844
7845 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7846 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7847 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7848
7849 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7850 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7851 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7852 @itemize @bullet
7853 @item no oob_* parameter
7854 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7855 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7856 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7857 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7858 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7859 @item @code{oob_only}
7860 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7861 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7862 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7863 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7864 @item @code{oob_raw}
7865 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7866 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7867 un-altered OOB.
7868 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7869 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7870 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7871 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7872 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7873 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7874 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7875 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7876 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7877 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7878 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7879 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7880 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7881 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7882 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7883 @end itemize
7884 @end deffn
7885
7886 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7887 @cindex NAND verification
7888 @cindex NAND programming
7889 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7890 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7891 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7892
7893 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7894 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7895
7896 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7897 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7898 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7899 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7900 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7901
7902 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7903 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7904 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7905
7906 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7907 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7908 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7909 be removed in a future release.
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @subsection Other NAND commands
7913 @cindex NAND other commands
7914
7915 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7916 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7917 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7918 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7919 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7920 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7921 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7922 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7923
7924 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7925 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7926 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7927 @end deffn
7928
7929 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7930 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7931 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7932 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7933 status for each block.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7937 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7938 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7939
7940 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7941 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7942 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7943 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7944 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7945
7946 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7947 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7948 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7949 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7950 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7951 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7952 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7953 @end deffn
7954
7955 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7956 @subsection NAND Driver List
7957 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7958 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7959 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7960
7961 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7962 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7963 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7964 address of the ECC controller.
7965 @example
7966 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7967 @end example
7968 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7969 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7970 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7971 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7972 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7973 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7974 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7975 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7976 @end deffn
7977 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7978 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7979 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7980 @end deffn
7981
7982 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7983 properly configured for input or output.
7984 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7985 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7986 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7987 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7988 @end deffn
7989 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7990 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7991 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7992 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7993 @end deffn
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7997 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7998 chips from Texas Instruments.
7999 It takes three extra parameters:
8000 address of the NAND chip;
8001 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8002 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8003 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8004 @example
8005 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8006 @end example
8007 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8008 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8009 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8010 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8011 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8015 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8016 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8017 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8018 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8019 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8020 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8021 @end deffn
8022
8023 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8024 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8025 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8026 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8027 @end deffn
8028 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8029
8030 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8031 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8032 should work for this chip as well.
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8036 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8037 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8038 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8039 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8040 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8041 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8042 @example
8043 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8044 @end example
8045 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8046 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8047 without parameter query status.
8048 @end deffn
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8052 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8053 parameter: the address of the controller.
8054 @example
8055 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8056 @end example
8057 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8058 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8059 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8060 change any behavior.
8061 @end deffn
8062
8063 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8064 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8065 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8066 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8067 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8068 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8069 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8070 specialized commands.
8071 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8072 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8073 change any behavior.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @node Flash Programming
8077 @chapter Flash Programming
8078
8079 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8080 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8081 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8082
8083 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8084 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8085
8086 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8087 @enumerate
8088 @item 'init' is executed.
8089 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8090 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8091 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8092 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8093 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8094 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8095 @end enumerate
8096
8097 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8098
8099 @example
8100 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8101 # are optional parameters
8102 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8103 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8104
8105 # binary files need the flash address passing
8106 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8107 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8108 @end example
8109
8110 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8111 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8112 @cindex PLD
8113 @cindex FPGA
8114
8115 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8116 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8117 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8118 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8119 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8120 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8121 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8122
8123 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8124
8125 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8126 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8127 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8128
8129 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8130 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8131
8132 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8133 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8134 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8135 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8136 behavior.
8137 @end deffn
8138
8139 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8140 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8141 @end deffn
8142
8143 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8144 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8145 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8146 @end deffn
8147
8148 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8149
8150 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8151 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8152 that particular type of PLD.
8153
8154 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8155 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8156 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8157
8158 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8159 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8160 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8161
8162 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8163 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8164 for FPGA @var{num}.
8165 @end deffn
8166 @end deffn
8167
8168 @node General Commands
8169 @chapter General Commands
8170 @cindex commands
8171
8172 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8173 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8174 commands are documented elsewhere.
8175
8176 Intent:
8177 @itemize @bullet
8178 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8179 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8180 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8181 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8182
8183 @item @b{From the human}
8184 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8185 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8186
8187 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8188 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8189 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8190
8191 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8192 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8193 port is 5555.
8194 @end itemize
8195
8196
8197 @section Server Commands
8198
8199 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8200 Exits the current telnet session.
8201 @end deffn
8202
8203 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8204 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8205 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8206 Not every command provides helptext.
8207
8208 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8209 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8210 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8211 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8212 @end deffn
8213
8214 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8215 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8216 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8217 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8218 Useful in connection with script files
8219 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8220 @end deffn
8221
8222 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8223 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8224 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8225 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8226
8227 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8228 @example
8229 # redefine shutdown
8230 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8231 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8232 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8233 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8234 original_shutdown
8235 @}
8236 @end example
8237 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8238 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @anchor{debuglevel}
8242 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8243 @cindex message level
8244 Display debug level.
8245 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8246 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8247 Level 0 is error messages only;
8248 level 1 adds warnings;
8249 level 2 adds informational messages;
8250 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8251 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8252 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8253 the command line along with the location of that log
8254 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8255 @xref{Running}.
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8259 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8260 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8261 @example
8262 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8263 @end example
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8267 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8268 the default log output channel is stderr.
8269 @end deffn
8270
8271 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8272 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8273 @end deffn
8274
8275 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8276 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8277 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8278 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8279 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8280 @end deffn
8281
8282 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8283 @section Target State handling
8284 @cindex reset
8285 @cindex halt
8286 @cindex target initialization
8287
8288 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8289 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8290 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8291 a current target which is used to perform the
8292 various operations. The current target may be changed
8293 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8294 target which should become current.
8295
8296 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8297 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8298 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8299 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8300 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8301
8302 @emph{With no arguments}:
8303 list all available registers for the current target,
8304 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8305 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8306 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8307 are flagged as such.
8308
8309 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8310 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8311 bypassing any internal cache.
8312
8313 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8314 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8315 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8316 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8317 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8318 relevant module will flush such values.
8319
8320 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8321 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8322
8323 @example
8324 > reg
8325 ===== ARM registers
8326 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8327 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8328 (2) r2 (/32)
8329 ...
8330 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8331 >
8332 @end example
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8336 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8337 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8338 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8339 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8340 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8341 (and enter debug mode).
8342 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8343
8344 @quotation Warning
8345 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8346 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8347 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8348 power mode by gating the core clock;
8349 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8350
8351 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8352 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8353 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8354 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8355 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8356 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8357
8358 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8359 work with a JTAG debugger.
8360 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8361 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8362 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8363 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8364 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8365 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8366 @end quotation
8367
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8371 Resume the target at its current code position,
8372 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8373 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8374 @end deffn
8375
8376 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8377 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8378 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @anchor{resetcommand}
8382 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8383 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8384 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8385 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8386 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8387 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8388 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8389
8390 The optional parameter specifies what should
8391 happen after the reset.
8392 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8393 The other options will not work on all systems.
8394 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8395
8396 @itemize @minus
8397 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8398 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8399 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8400 @end itemize
8401 @end deffn
8402
8403 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8404 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8405 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8406 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8407 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8408 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8409 state.
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8413 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8414 Set values of reset signals.
8415 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8416 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8417 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8418 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8419
8420 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8421 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8422 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8423 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8424 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8425 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8426 the signal will not be modified.
8427
8428 @quotation Note
8429 TRST is specially handled.
8430 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8431 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8432 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8433 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8434 instead of the TRST signal.
8435 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8436 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8437 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8438 with handlers for that event.
8439 @end quotation
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8443 @section Memory access commands
8444 @cindex memory access
8445
8446 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8447 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8448 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8449 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8450
8451 @enumerate
8452 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8453 to change the current target.
8454 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8455 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8456 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8457 @end enumerate
8458
8459 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8460 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8461 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8462 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8463 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8464 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8465 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8466 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8467 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8468 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8469 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8470 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8471 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8472 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8473 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8477 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8478 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8479 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8480 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8481 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8482 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8483 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8484 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8485 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8486 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8487 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 @anchor{imageaccess}
8491 @section Image loading commands
8492 @cindex image loading
8493 @cindex image dumping
8494
8495 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8496 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8497 binary file named @var{filename}.
8498 @end deffn
8499
8500 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8501 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8502 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8506 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8507 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8508 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8509 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8510 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8511 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8512 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8513 separately.
8514 @end deffn
8515
8516 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8517 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8518 The file format may optionally be specified
8519 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8520 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8521 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8522 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8523 @example
8524 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8525 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8526 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8527 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8528 $address $length
8529 @}
8530 @end example
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8534 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8535 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8536 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8537 The file format may optionally be specified
8538 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8539 @end deffn
8540
8541 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8542 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8543 The file format may optionally be specified
8544 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8545 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8549 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8550 The file format may optionally be specified
8551 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8552 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555
8556 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8557 @cindex breakpoint
8558 @cindex watchpoint
8559
8560 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8561 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8562 watchpoints.
8563 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8564
8565 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8566 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8567 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8568 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8569 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8570 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8571
8572 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8573 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8574 @end deffn
8575
8576 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8577 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8581 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8585 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8586 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8587 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8588 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8589 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8590 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8591 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8592 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8593 @end deffn
8594
8595
8596 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8597
8598 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8599 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8600 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8601 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8602 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8603 running, can be used.
8604 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8605 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8606 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8607
8608 @quotation Note
8609 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8610 @end quotation
8611
8612 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8613 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8614 communication, respectively.
8615
8616 @quotation Note
8617 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8618 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8619 example.
8620 @end quotation
8621
8622 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8623 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8624 of TCP/IP connections.
8625
8626 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8627 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8628 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8629 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8630 @var{size} bytes.
8631 @end deffn
8632
8633 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8634 Start RTT.
8635 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8636 @end deffn
8637
8638 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8639 Stop RTT.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8643 Display the polling interval.
8644 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8645 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8646 checked for new data.
8647 @end deffn
8648
8649 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8650 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8651 @end deffn
8652
8653 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8654 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8655 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8659 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8660 @end deffn
8661
8662 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8663 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8667 on the target device.
8668
8669 @example
8670 resume
8671
8672 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8673 rtt start
8674
8675 rtt server start 9090 0
8676 @end example
8677
8678 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8679 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8680 TCP/IP port 9090.
8681
8682
8683 @section Misc Commands
8684
8685 @cindex profiling
8686 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8687 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8688 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8689 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8690 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8691 limit the address range.
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 @deffn {Command} {version}
8695 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8699 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8700 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8704 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8705 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8706 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8707
8708 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8709 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8710 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8711 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8712
8713 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8714 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8715 @cindex tracing
8716 @cindex ETM
8717 @cindex ETB
8718
8719 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8720 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8721 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8722
8723 @itemize
8724 @item
8725 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8726 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8727 supports such an interface.
8728 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8729 and trace port support.)
8730 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8731 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8732 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8733 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8734 in the board-specific configuration file.
8735 @item
8736 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8737 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8738 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8739 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8740 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8741 @end itemize
8742
8743 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8744
8745 @quotation Issues
8746 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8747 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8748
8749 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8750 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8751 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8752 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8753 dummy trace port driver}.
8754
8755 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8756 as well as tracing only during specific states
8757 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8758
8759 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8760 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8761 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8762 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8763 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8764
8765 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8766 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8767 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8768 this original style of JTAG access.
8769 @end quotation
8770
8771 @subsection ETM Configuration
8772 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8773
8774 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8775 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8776 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8777
8778 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8779 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8780 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8781 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8782 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8783 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8784 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8785 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8786 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8787
8788 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8789 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8790 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8791
8792 @quotation Warning
8793 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8794 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8795 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8796 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8797 @end quotation
8798
8799 @quotation Note
8800 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8801 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8802 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8803 what CPU activities are traced.
8804 @end quotation
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8808 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8809 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8810 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8811 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8815 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8816 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8817 Did trace data overflow?
8818 Was it triggered?
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8822 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8823 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8824 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8825 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8826
8827 @itemize
8828 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8829 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8830 The value is one of
8831 @option{none} (save nothing),
8832 @option{data} (save data),
8833 @option{address} (save addresses),
8834 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8835 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8836 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8837 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8838 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8839 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8840 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8841 trace stream without an image of the code.
8842 @end itemize
8843 @end deffn
8844
8845 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8846 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8847 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8848 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8849 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8850
8851 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8852 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8853 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8854 @end deffn
8855
8856 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8857
8858 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8859 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8860 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8861
8862 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8863 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8864 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8865 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8866 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8867 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8868 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8869
8870 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8871
8872 @itemize
8873 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8874 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8875 for instruction access within that function's body.
8876 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8877 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8878 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8879 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8880 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8881 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8882 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8883 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8884 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8885 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8886 @item @emph{... more}
8887 @end itemize
8888
8889 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8890 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8891
8892 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8893 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8894 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8895 @end deffn
8896
8897 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8898 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8899 @end deffn
8900
8901 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8902 Opens an image file.
8903 @end deffn
8904
8905 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8906 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8910 Starts trace data collection.
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8914 Stops trace data collection.
8915 @end deffn
8916
8917 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8918 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8919
8920 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8921
8922 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8923 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8924 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8925 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8926 any trace data collection.}
8927 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8928 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8929 @end deffn
8930 @end deffn
8931
8932 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8933 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8934 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8935 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8936 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8937 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8938 @end deffn
8939 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8940 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8941 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8942 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8943 trace trigger becomes active.
8944
8945 @itemize
8946 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8947 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8948 afterwards.
8949 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8950 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8951 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8952 what caused that event to happen.
8953 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8954 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8955 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8956 how the event caused trouble.
8957 @end itemize
8958 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8959 @end deffn
8960
8961 @end deffn
8962
8963 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8964 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8965 @cindex CTI
8966
8967 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8968 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8969 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8970 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8971 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8972 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8973
8974 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8975 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8976 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8977 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8978 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8979 including additional configuration.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8983 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8984 @end deffn
8985
8986 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8987 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8988 @end deffn
8989
8990 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8991 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8992 @end deffn
8993
8994 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8995 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8996 @end deffn
8997
8998 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8999 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9000 @end deffn
9001
9002 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9003 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9004 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9005 @end deffn
9006
9007 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9008 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9009 of the CTI.
9010 @end deffn
9011
9012 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9013 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9014 useful in TCL scripting.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @section Generic ARM
9018 @cindex ARM
9019
9020 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9021 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9022 commands that may be available.
9023
9024 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9025 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9026 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9027 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9028 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9029 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9030 @end deffn
9031
9032 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9033 @cindex disassemble
9034 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9035 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9036 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9037 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9038 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9039 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9040 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9041
9042 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9043 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9044 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9045 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9046 with a handful of exceptions.
9047 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9048 @end deffn
9049
9050 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9051 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9052 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9053 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9054 and using the MCR instruction.
9055 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9056 an ARM register.)
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9060 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9061 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9062 and the MRC instruction.
9063 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9064 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9065 an ARM register.)
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9069 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9070 core mode if necessary.
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9074 @cindex ARM semihosting
9075 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9076
9077 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9078 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9079 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9080 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9081 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9082 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9086 @cindex ARM semihosting
9087 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9088
9089 @example
9090 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9091 @end example
9092
9093 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9094 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9095 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9096 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9100 @cindex ARM semihosting
9101 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9102 status.
9103
9104 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9105 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9106 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9107 debugger.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9111 @cindex ARM semihosting
9112 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9113
9114 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9115 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9116 the value returned by the target.
9117
9118 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9119 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9120 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9121 encountering a break.
9122
9123 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9124 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9125 to the debugger.
9126 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9127 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9128 request or equivalent").
9129
9130 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9131 this option (default: disabled).
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9135 @cindex ARMv4
9136 @cindex ARMv5
9137
9138 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9139 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9140 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9141 variant.
9142
9143 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9144 @cindex ARM7
9145 @cindex ARM9
9146
9147 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9148 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9149 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9150 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9151
9152 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9153 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9154 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9155 instead of breakpoints.
9156 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9157
9158 This should be
9159 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9160 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9161 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9162 @end deffn
9163
9164 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9165 @cindex DCC
9166 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9167 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9168 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9169
9170 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9171 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9172 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9176 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9177 that don't check completion of the operation.
9178 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9179
9180 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9181 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9182 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9183 @end deffn
9184
9185 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9186 @cindex ARM9
9187
9188 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9189 integer processors.
9190 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9191
9192 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9193 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9194 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9195 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9196
9197 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9198 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9199 @cindex vector_catch
9200 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9201 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9202 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9203 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9204 to those hardware vectors.
9205
9206 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9207 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9208 vector catch hardware to intercept
9209 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9210 @option{none} of them,
9211 or a list with one or more of the following:
9212 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9213 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9214 @end deffn
9215
9216 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9217 @cindex ARM920T
9218
9219 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9220 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9221 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9222 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9223 and ARM9 commands.
9224
9225 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9226 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9227 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9228 @end deffn
9229
9230 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9231 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9232 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9233 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9234 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9235 (Not all registers can be written.)
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9239 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9240 @end deffn
9241
9242 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9243 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9244 @end deffn
9245
9246 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9247 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9248
9249 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9250 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9251 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9252 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9253 and ARM9 commands.
9254
9255 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9256 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9257
9258 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9259 Print information about the caches found.
9260 @end deffn
9261
9262 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9263 @cindex ARM966E
9264
9265 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9266 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9267 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9268 and ARM9 commands.
9269
9270 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9271 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9272 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9273 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9274 ARM966E-S TRM.
9275 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9276 as required for BIST support.
9277 @end deffn
9278
9279 @subsection XScale specific commands
9280 @cindex XScale
9281
9282 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9283
9284 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9285 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9286 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9287 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9288 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9289 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9290 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9291
9292 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9293 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9294 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9295 the mini-IC.
9296
9297 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9298 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9299 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9300 code layout in memory:
9301 @example
9302 _vectors:
9303 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9304 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9305 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9306 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9307 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9308 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9309 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9310 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9311 .org 0x100
9312 .long real_reset_vector
9313 .long real_ui_handler
9314 .long real_swi_handler
9315 .long real_pf_abort
9316 .long real_data_abort
9317 .long 0 /* unused */
9318 .long real_irq_handler
9319 .long real_fiq_handler
9320 @end example
9321
9322 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9323 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9324 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9325 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9326 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9327 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9328 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9329 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9330 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9331 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9332 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9333 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9334 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9335 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9336 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9337 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9338 software.
9339
9340 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9341 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9342 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9343 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9344
9345 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9346 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9347 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9348 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9349 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9350 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9351 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9352 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9353 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9354
9355 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9356 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9357
9358 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9359 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9363 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9364 @end deffn
9365
9366 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9367 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9368 @end deffn
9369
9370 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9371 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9372 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9376 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9380 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9384 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9385 @end deffn
9386
9387 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9388 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9389 @end deffn
9390
9391 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9392 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9393 @end deffn
9394
9395 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9396 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9397 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9398 and modifying how it is emptied.
9399 @end deffn
9400
9401 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9402 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9403 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9404 The image @var{type} may be one of
9405 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9406 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9407 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9411 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9412 @cindex vector_catch
9413 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9414 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9415
9416 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9417 @example
9418 0x01 Trap Reset
9419 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9420 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9421 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9422 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9423 0x20 reserved
9424 0x40 Trap IRQ
9425 0x80 Trap FIQ
9426 @end example
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9430 @cindex vector_table
9431
9432 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9433 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9434 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9435 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9436 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9437
9438 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9439
9440 @end deffn
9441
9442 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9443 @cindex ARMv6
9444
9445 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9446 @cindex ARM11
9447
9448 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9449 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9450 which is enabled by default.
9451 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9452 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9453 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9454 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9455 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9456 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9457 @end deffn
9458
9459 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9460 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9461 which is enabled by default.
9462 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9463 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9467 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9468 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9469 they are disabled by default.
9470 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9474 @cindex vector_catch
9475 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9476 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9477 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9478
9479 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9480 for certain hardware events.
9481 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9482 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9483 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9487 @cindex ARMv7
9488 @cindex ARMv8
9489
9490 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9491 @cindex Cortex-A
9492
9493 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9494 display information about target caches
9495 @end deffn
9496
9497 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9498 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9499 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9500 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9501 Defaults to 'off'.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9505 Initialize core debug
9506 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9507 @end deffn
9508
9509 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9510 Display/set the current SMP mode
9511 @end deffn
9512
9513 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9514 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9515 @end deffn
9516
9517 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9518 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9519 @end deffn
9520
9521 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9522 configure l2x cache
9523 @end deffn
9524
9525 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9526 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9527 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9528 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9529 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9533 @cindex Cortex-R
9534
9535 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9536 Initialize core debug
9537 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9538 @end deffn
9539
9540 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9541 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544
9545 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9546 @cindex tracing
9547 @cindex SWO
9548 @cindex SWV
9549 @cindex TPIU
9550
9551 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9552 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9553 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9554 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9555
9556 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9557 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9558 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9559 which causes quite some confusion.
9560 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9561 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9562
9563 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9564 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9565 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9566
9567 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9568 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9569 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9573 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9574 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9575 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9576
9577 @itemize @bullet
9578 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9579 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9580 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9581 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9582
9583 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9584 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9585 @end itemize
9586 @end deffn
9587
9588 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9589 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9590 @end deffn
9591
9592 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9593 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9594 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9595 at any time after the initialization, too.
9596 @end deffn
9597
9598 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9599 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9600 individually queried, to return its current value.
9601 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9602 @end deffn
9603
9604 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9605 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9606 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9607 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9608
9609 @itemize @bullet
9610 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9611 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9612
9613 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9614 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9615
9616 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9617 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9618
9619 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9620 protocol used for trace data:
9621 @itemize @minus
9622 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9623 data bits (default);
9624 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9625 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9626 @end itemize
9627
9628 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9629 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9630 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9631 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9632 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9633 of the TPIU.
9634
9635 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9636 the destination of the trace data:
9637 @itemize @minus
9638 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9639 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9640 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9641 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9642 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9643 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9644 each connected client;
9645 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9646 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9647 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9648 @end itemize
9649
9650 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9651 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9652 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9653 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9654
9655 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9656 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9657 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9658 maximum supported rate automatically.
9659
9660 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9661 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9662 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9663
9664 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9665 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9666 default value is @var{0}.
9667 @end itemize
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9671 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9672 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9673 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9674 data.
9675 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9676 after the @command{init}.
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9680 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683
9684
9685 Example usage:
9686 @enumerate
9687 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9688 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9689 enough to:
9690 @example
9691 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9692 ...
9693 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9694 ...
9695 @end example
9696 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9697 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9698 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9699 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9700 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9701 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9702 @example
9703 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9704 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9705 @end example
9706 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9707 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9708 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9709 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9710 @example
9711 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9712 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9713 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9714 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9715 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9716 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9717 @end example
9718 @end enumerate
9719
9720 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9721 @cindex tracing
9722 @cindex SWO
9723 @cindex SWV
9724 @cindex ITM
9725 @cindex ETM
9726
9727 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9728 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9729 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9730 @end deffn
9731
9732 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9733 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9734 @end deffn
9735
9736 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9737 @cindex Cortex-M
9738
9739 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9740 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9741
9742 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9743 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9744 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9745 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9746 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9747 the step command leaves with the core running.
9748
9749 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9750 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9751 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9752 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9753
9754 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9755 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9756 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9757 does.
9758
9759 Default is @option{auto}.
9760 @end deffn
9761
9762 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9763 @cindex vector_catch
9764 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9765 for certain hardware events.
9766
9767 Parameters request interception of
9768 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9769 @option{none} of them,
9770 or one or more of the following:
9771 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9772 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9773 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9774 @option{irq_err},
9775 @option{state_err},
9776 @option{chk_err}, or
9777 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9778 @option{reset}.
9779 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9780 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9781 are mapped to HardFault.
9782 UsageFault checks for
9783 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9784 must also be explicitly enabled.
9785
9786 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9787 @end deffn
9788
9789 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9790 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9791 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9792
9793 @itemize @minus
9794 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9795 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9796 @end itemize
9797
9798 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9799 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9800 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9801 to manually reset the peripherals.
9802 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9803
9804 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9805 instead.
9806 @end deffn
9807
9808 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9809 @cindex ARMv8-A
9810 @cindex aarch64
9811
9812 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9813 Display information about target caches
9814 @end deffn
9815
9816 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9817 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9818 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9819 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9820 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9821 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9822 @end deffn
9823
9824 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9825 @cindex disassemble
9826 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9827 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9828 @end deffn
9829
9830 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9831 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9832 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9833 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9834 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9838 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9839 @option{on}.
9840 @end deffn
9841
9842 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9843 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9844 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9845 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9846 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9847 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9848 @end deffn
9849
9850 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9851
9852 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9853 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9854
9855 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9856
9857 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9858 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9859 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9860 @end deffn
9861
9862 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9863 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9864 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9865 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9866 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9867 @end deffn
9868
9869 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9872 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9873 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9877
9878 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9879 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9880 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9881 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9882 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9883 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9884 can be collected.
9885
9886 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9887 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9888 tooling.
9889
9890 @quotation Issues
9891 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9892 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9893 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9894 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9895
9896 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9897 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9898 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9899 software operation on the CPU.
9900 @end quotation
9901
9902 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9903 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9904 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9905 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9906 @end deffn
9907
9908 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9909 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9910 @end deffn
9911
9912 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9913 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9914 control is disabled.
9915 @end deffn
9916
9917 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9918 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9919 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9920 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9921
9922 Supported trace formats:
9923 @itemize
9924 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9925 timing to be determined.
9926 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9927 addresses.
9928 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9929 @end itemize
9930 @end deffn
9931
9932 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9933 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9934 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9935 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9936
9937 Supported conditions:
9938 @itemize
9939 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9940 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9941 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9942 instruction matches start data and mask.
9943 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9944 instruction matches start data and mask.
9945 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9946 data and mask.
9947 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9948 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9949 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9950 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9951 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9952 @end itemize
9953 @end deffn
9954
9955 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9956 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9957 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9958 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9959
9960 Supported conditions:
9961 @itemize
9962 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9963 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9964 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9965 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9966 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9967 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9968 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9969 data and mask.
9970 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9971 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9972 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9973 @end itemize
9974 @end deffn
9975
9976 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9977 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9978
9979 Supported triggers:
9980 @itemize
9981 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9982 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9983 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9984 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9985 collection.
9986 @end itemize
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9990
9991 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9992 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9993 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9994 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9995 @end deffn
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9998 Display trace configuration.
9999 @end deffn
10000
10001 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10002 Display trace collection status.
10003 @end deffn
10004
10005 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10006 Start manual trace collection.
10007 @end deffn
10008
10009 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10010 Stop manual trace collection.
10011 @end deffn
10012
10013 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10014 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10015 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10016 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10017 @option{size} options using DMA.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10021 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10022 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10023 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10024 @option{size} options using DMA.
10025 @end deffn
10026
10027 @section Intel Architecture
10028
10029 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10030 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10031 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10032 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10033 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10034 @itemize
10035 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10036 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10037 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10038 @end itemize
10039
10040 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10041 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10042 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10045 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10049 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10053 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10054 @end deffn
10055
10056 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10057 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10061 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10065 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10066 @end deffn
10067
10068 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10069
10070 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10071 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10072
10073 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10074 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10075 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10076 @end deffn
10077 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10078 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10079
10080 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10081
10082 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10083 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10084 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10085 @end deffn
10086
10087 @subsection Registers commands
10088 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10089 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10090 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10091
10092 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10093
10094 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10095 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10096 and "timer" groups.
10097
10098 @emph{example:}
10099 @example
10100 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10101 @end example
10102
10103 @end deffn
10104
10105 @section RISC-V Architecture
10106
10107 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10108 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10109 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10110 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10111 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10112 implement version 0.11.
10113
10114 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10115
10116 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10117 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10118 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10119
10120 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10121
10122 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10123 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10124 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10125
10126 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10127 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10128 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10129 CSRs.
10130 @end deffn
10131
10132 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10133 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10134 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10135 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10136 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10137 This command must be executed before `init`.
10138 @end deffn
10139
10140 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10141 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10142 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10143 @end deffn
10144
10145 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10146 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10147 deasserted.
10148 @end deffn
10149
10150 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10151 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10152 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10153 @end deffn
10154
10155 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10156 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10157 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10158 on physical memory.
10159 @end deffn
10160
10161 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10162 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10163 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10164 performed on physical memory.
10165 @end deffn
10166
10167 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10168 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10169 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10170 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10171 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10172 race condition problem in your code.
10173
10174 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10175 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10179 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10180 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10181 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10182 values.
10183
10184 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10185 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10186 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10187 @end deffn
10188
10189 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10190 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10191 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10192 @end deffn
10193
10194 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10195 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10196 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10197 @end deffn
10198
10199 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10200 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10201 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10205 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10206 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10207 @end deffn
10208
10209 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10210
10211 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10212 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10213 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10214 @example
10215 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10216 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10217 @end example
10218
10219 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10220 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10221 @end deffn
10222
10223 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10224 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10228
10229 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10230 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10231
10232 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10233 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10234 @end deffn
10235
10236 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10237 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10238 @end deffn
10239
10240 @section ARC Architecture
10241 @cindex ARC
10242
10243 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10244 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10245 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10246 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10247 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10248 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10249 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10250 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10251 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10252 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10253 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10254 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10255 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10256 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10257 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10258
10259
10260 @subsection General ARC commands
10261
10262 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10263
10264 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10265 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10266 arguments:
10267
10268 @itemize @bullet
10269
10270 @item @code{-name} name
10271 @*Name of a register.
10272
10273 @item @code{-num} number
10274 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10275
10276 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10277 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10278
10279 @end itemize
10280
10281 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10282
10283 @itemize @bullet
10284
10285 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10286 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10287 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10288 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10289 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10290 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10291
10292 @item @code{-core}
10293 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10294 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10295 spaces.
10296
10297 @item @code{-bcr}
10298 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10299 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10300 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10301 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10302 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10303
10304 @item @code{-type} type_name
10305 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10306 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10307
10308 @item @code{-g}
10309 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10310 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10311 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10312 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10313 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10314
10315 @end itemize
10316
10317 @end deffn
10318
10319 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10320 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10321 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10322 @end deffn
10323
10324 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10325 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10326 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10327 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10328 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10329 startbit endbit}.
10330 @end deffn
10331
10332 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10333 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10334 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10335 @end deffn
10336
10337 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10338 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10339 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10343
10344 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10345 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10346 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10347 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10348
10349 @end deffn
10350
10351 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10352 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10353 registers.
10354 @end deffn
10355
10356 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10357 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10358 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10359 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10360
10361 @end deffn
10362
10363 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10364 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10365 registers.
10366 @end deffn
10367
10368 @section STM8 Architecture
10369 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10370 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10371
10372 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10373 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10374
10375 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10376 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10377 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10378 @cindex tracing
10379 @cindex libdcc
10380 @cindex DCC
10381 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10382 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10383 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10384 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10385
10386 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10387 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10388 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10389 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10390 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10391 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10392
10393 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10394 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10395 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10396 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10397 The target being debugged may
10398 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10399 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10400 each supported by a command:
10401
10402 @itemize
10403 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10404 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10405 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10406 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10407
10408 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10409 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10410 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10411
10412 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10413 and then displayed at any time.
10414 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10415
10416 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10417 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10418 @end itemize
10419
10420 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10421 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10422 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10423 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10424 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10425 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10426 does the same thing.
10427
10428 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10429 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10430 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10431 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10432 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10433
10434 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10435 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10436 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10437 @end deffn
10438
10439 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10440 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10441 in the order they triggered.
10442 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10443 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10444 history records.
10445 @end deffn
10446
10447 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10448 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10449 they have been triggered.
10450 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10451 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10452 and associates it with that identifier.
10453
10454 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10455 are not related except by this command.
10456 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10457 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10458 @end deffn
10459
10460
10461 @node JTAG Commands
10462 @chapter JTAG Commands
10463 @cindex JTAG Commands
10464 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10465 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10466 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10467 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10468 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10469
10470 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10471 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10472
10473 @itemize @bullet
10474 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10475 devices such as a CPUs.
10476 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10477 standard state machine (in parallel)
10478 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10479 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10480 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10481 while the reading previous ones.
10482 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10483 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10484 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10485 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10486 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10487 registers.
10488 @end itemize
10489
10490 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10491
10492 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10493 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10494 the order of TAP state transitions.
10495 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10496 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10497 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10498 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10499 these commands are not available.
10500
10501 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10502 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10503 that specify the entire register.
10504 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10505 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10506 The return value holds the original value of each
10507 of those fields.
10508
10509 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10510 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10511 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10512 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10513 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10514
10515 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10516 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10517
10518 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10519 in that state.
10520 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10521 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10522 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10523
10524 @quotation Warning
10525 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10526 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10527 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10528 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10529 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10530 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10531 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10532 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10533 @end quotation
10534 @end deffn
10535
10536 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10537 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10538 This may be used for performance tuning.
10539
10540 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10541 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10542 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10543 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10544 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10545 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10546 @end deffn
10547
10548 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10549 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10550 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10551 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10552 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10553 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10554
10555 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10556 in that state.
10557 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10558 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10559 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10560
10561 @quotation Note
10562 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10563 register values, unlike data register values.
10564 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10565 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10566 @end quotation
10567 @end deffn
10568
10569 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10570 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10571 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10572 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10573 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10574 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10575 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10576 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10577 The final state must also be stable.
10578 @end deffn
10579
10580 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10581 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10582 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10583 Instructions often need some time
10584 to execute before they take effect.
10585 @end deffn
10586
10587 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10588 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10589
10590 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10591 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10592 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10593 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10594 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10595 @end deffn
10596
10597 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10598 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10599 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10600 must also be enabled.
10601 Default is enabled.
10602 @end deffn
10603
10604 @section TAP state names
10605 @cindex TAP state names
10606
10607 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10608 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10609 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10610 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10611
10612 @itemize @bullet
10613 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10614 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10615 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10616 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10617 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10618 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10619 through the data register
10620 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10621 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10622 for update or more shifting
10623 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10624 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10625 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10626 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10627 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10628 through the instruction register
10629 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10630 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10631 for update or more shifting
10632 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10633 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10634 @end itemize
10635
10636 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10637 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10638 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10639 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10640
10641 @itemize @bullet
10642 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10643 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10644 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10645 may not be as expected.
10646 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10647 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10648 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10649 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10650 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10651 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10652 @end itemize
10653
10654 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10655 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10656
10657 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10658 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10659 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10660 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10661
10662 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10663 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10664 @cindex SVF
10665
10666 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10667 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10668 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10669 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10670
10671 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10672 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10673 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10674 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10675
10676 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10677 affect their semantics.
10678
10679 Command options:
10680 @itemize @minus
10681 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10682 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10683 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10684 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10685 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10686 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10687 on the real interface;
10688 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10689 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10690 errors.
10691 @end itemize
10692 @end deffn
10693
10694 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10695 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10696 @cindex XSVF
10697
10698 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10699 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10700 Xilinx devices.
10701 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10702 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10703
10704 @quotation Important
10705 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10706 @end quotation
10707
10708 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10709 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10710 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10711 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10712 that TAP.
10713 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10714 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10715 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10716 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10717 @end deffn
10718
10719 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10720 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10721 after building the software.
10722 You may find them useful:
10723
10724 @itemize
10725 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10726 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10727 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10728 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10729 @end itemize
10730
10731 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10732 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10733 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10734 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10735 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10736 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10737 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10738
10739
10740 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10741 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10742 @cindex IPDBG
10743
10744 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10745 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10746 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10747 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10748 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10749 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10750
10751 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10752 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10753
10754 Command options:
10755 @itemize @bullet
10756 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10757 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10758 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10759 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10760 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10761 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10762 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10763 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10764 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10765 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10766 shift data through vir can be configured.
10767 @end itemize
10768 @end deffn
10769
10770 Examples:
10771 @example
10772 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10773 @end example
10774 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10775 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10776
10777 @example
10778 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10779 @end example
10780 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10781 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10782
10783 @node Utility Commands
10784 @chapter Utility Commands
10785 @cindex Utility Commands
10786
10787 @section RAM testing
10788 @cindex RAM testing
10789
10790 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10791 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10792 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10793 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10794 hardware problems.
10795
10796 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10797 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10798 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10799 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10800
10801 Load the memory testing functions with
10802
10803 @example
10804 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10805 @end example
10806
10807 to get access to the following facilities:
10808
10809 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10810 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10811 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10812 @end deffn
10813
10814 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10815 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10816 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10817 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10818 @end deffn
10819
10820 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10821 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10822 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10823 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10824 @end deffn
10825
10826 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10827 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10828 @end deffn
10829
10830 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10831 @cindex Firmware recovery
10832
10833 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10834 devices recovery with JTAG.
10835
10836 For quickstart instructions run:
10837 @example
10838 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10839 @end example
10840
10841 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10842 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10843 @cindex GDB
10844 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10845 to debug remote targets.
10846 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10847
10848 @itemize
10849 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10850 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10851 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10852 as shown in this chapter.
10853 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10854 that also will probably need to be configured.
10855 @end itemize
10856
10857 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10858 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10859 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10860 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10861 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10862 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10863
10864 @section Connecting to GDB
10865 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10866 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10867 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10868 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10869 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10870
10871 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10872
10873 @enumerate
10874 @item
10875 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10876 @example
10877 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10878 @end example
10879 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10880
10881 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10882 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10883 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10884
10885 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10886 remote command above that becomes:
10887 @example
10888 tar ext :3333
10889 @end example
10890
10891 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10892 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10893 available through the command:
10894 @example
10895 target remote localhost:3333
10896 @end example
10897
10898 @item
10899 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10900 @example
10901 target extended-remote | \
10902 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10903 @end example
10904 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10905 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10906 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10907 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10908 @end enumerate
10909
10910 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10911 GDB command line.
10912
10913 @section Sample GDB session startup
10914
10915 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10916 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10917 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10918 small ARM program.
10919 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10920 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10921
10922 @example
10923 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10924 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10925 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10926 ...
10927 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10928 ...
10929 (gdb) load
10930 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10931 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10932 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10933 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10934 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10935 (gdb) continue
10936 Continuing.
10937 ...
10938 @end example
10939
10940 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10941 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10942 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10943 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10944
10945 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10946
10947 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10948 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10949 packet size and the device's memory map.
10950 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10951 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10952 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10953
10954 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10955 You may need to set those up by hand.
10956 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10957 something like:
10958
10959 @example
10960 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10961 @end example
10962
10963 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10964
10965 @example
10966 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10967 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10968 @end example
10969
10970 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10971 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10972 do not have such restrictions.
10973
10974 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10975 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10976 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10977 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10978
10979 @section Programming using GDB
10980 @cindex Programming using GDB
10981 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10982
10983 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10984 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10985 @example
10986 gdb_memory_map disable
10987 @end example
10988 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10989 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10990 working area.
10991
10992 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10993 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10994 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10995 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10996
10997 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10998 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10999
11000 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11001 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11002 @example
11003 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11004 @end example
11005
11006 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11007 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11008
11009 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11010 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11011 will be used.
11012
11013 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11014 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11015 @example
11016 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11017 @end example
11018 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11019
11020 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11021 can be used.
11022
11023 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11024 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11025 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11026
11027 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11028 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11029 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11030
11031 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11032 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11033 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11034 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11035 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11036 without any intrusion of the target process.
11037
11038 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11039 Place following command after target configuration:
11040 @example
11041 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11042 @end example
11043
11044 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11045 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11046 @example
11047 gdb_memory_map disable
11048 @end example
11049
11050 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11051 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11052 @example
11053 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11054 @end example
11055
11056 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11057 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11058
11059 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11060 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11061 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11062 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11063
11064 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11065 previously shown variables.
11066
11067 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11068 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11069 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11070 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11071 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11072
11073 @section RTOS Support
11074 @cindex RTOS Support
11075 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11076
11077 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11078 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11079
11080 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11081 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11082 GDB commands.
11083
11084 @* An example setup is below:
11085
11086 @example
11087 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11088 @end example
11089
11090 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11091
11092 Currently supported rtos's include:
11093 @itemize @bullet
11094 @item @option{eCos}
11095 @item @option{ThreadX}
11096 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11097 @item @option{linux}
11098 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11099 @item @option{embKernel}
11100 @item @option{mqx}
11101 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11102 @item @option{nuttx}
11103 @item @option{RIOT}
11104 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11105 @item @option{Zephyr}
11106 @end itemize
11107
11108 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11109 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11110
11111 @table @code
11112 @item eCos symbols
11113 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11114 @item ThreadX symbols
11115 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11116 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11117 @raggedright
11118 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11119 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11120 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11121 @end raggedright
11122 @item linux symbols
11123 init_task.
11124 @item ChibiOS symbols
11125 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11126 @item embKernel symbols
11127 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11128 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11129 @item mqx symbols
11130 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11131 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11132 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11133 @item nuttx symbols
11134 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11135 @item RIOT symbols
11136 @raggedright
11137 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11138 _tcb_name_offset.
11139 @end raggedright
11140 @item Zephyr symbols
11141 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11142 @end table
11143
11144 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11145 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11146
11147 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11148 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11149
11150 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11151 along with the project:
11152
11153 @table @code
11154 @item FreeRTOS
11155 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11156 @item uC/OS-III
11157 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11158 @end table
11159
11160 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11161 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11162 @cindex SMP
11163 @cindex RTOS
11164 @cindex hwthread
11165 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11166 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11167 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11168 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11169 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11170 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11171 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11172 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11173 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11174
11175 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11176 @quotation Note
11177 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11178 @end quotation
11179
11180 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11181 @itemize @bullet
11182 @item j - smp status request
11183 @item J - smp set request
11184 @end itemize
11185
11186 OpenOCD implements :
11187 @itemize @bullet
11188 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11189 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11190 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11191 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11192 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11193 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11194 @end itemize
11195
11196 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11197 @itemize @bullet
11198 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11199 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11200 @example
11201 set $_core 1
11202 #Jc01 packet is sent
11203 print $_core
11204 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11205 @end example
11206
11207 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11208 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11209
11210 @example
11211 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11212 define toggle0
11213 maint packet Jc0
11214 continue
11215 main packet Jc-1
11216 end
11217 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11218 define toggle1
11219 maint packet Jc1
11220 continue
11221 main packet Jc-1
11222 end
11223 @end example
11224 @end itemize
11225
11226 @node Tcl Scripting API
11227 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11228 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11229 @cindex Tcl scripts
11230 @section API rules
11231
11232 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11233 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11234 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11235
11236 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11237 pair list and lists.
11238
11239 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11240 list.
11241
11242 @example
11243 > set foo(me) Duane
11244 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11245 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11246 > set foo(duck) Donald
11247 @end example
11248
11249 If one does this:
11250
11251 @example
11252 > set foo
11253 @end example
11254
11255 The result is:
11256
11257 @example
11258 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11259 @end example
11260
11261 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11262
11263 @verbatim
11264 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11265 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11266 }
11267 @end verbatim
11268
11269 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11270 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11271
11272 @section Internal low-level Commands
11273
11274 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11275 invoke directly.
11276
11277 @itemize @bullet
11278 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11279
11280 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11281 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11282
11283 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11284 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11285
11286 Return information about the flash banks
11287
11288 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11289
11290 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11291 its execution. Example:
11292
11293 @example
11294 > capture "reset init"
11295 @end example
11296
11297 @end itemize
11298
11299 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11300 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11301 called "flash_banks".
11302
11303 @section Tcl RPC server
11304 @cindex RPC
11305
11306 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11307 commands and receive the results.
11308
11309 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11310 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11311 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11312 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11313 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11314
11315 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11316 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11317 @command{capture} command.
11318
11319 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11320
11321 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11322 @cindex RPC Notifications
11323
11324 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11325 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11326
11327 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11328 in the following format.
11329
11330 @verbatim
11331 type target_event event [event-name]
11332 type target_state state [state-name]
11333 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11334 @end verbatim
11335
11336 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11337 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11338 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11339 Defaults to off.
11340
11341 @end deffn
11342
11343 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11344 @cindex RPC trace output
11345
11346 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11347 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11348
11349 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11350
11351 @verbatim
11352 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11353 @end verbatim
11354
11355 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11356 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11357 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11358 Defaults to off.
11359
11360 See an example application here:
11361 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11362
11363 @end deffn
11364
11365 @node FAQ
11366 @chapter FAQ
11367 @cindex faq
11368 @enumerate
11369 @anchor{faqrtck}
11370 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11371 @cindex RTCK
11372 @cindex adaptive clocking
11373 @*
11374
11375 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11376 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11377 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11378 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11379
11380 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11381 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11382 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11383 @enumerate
11384 @item
11385 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11386 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11387 @item
11388 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11389 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11390 @end enumerate
11391
11392 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11393 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11394 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11395 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11396 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11397 power).
11398
11399 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11400 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11401 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11402 ARM926 scenario).
11403 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11404 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11405 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11406
11407 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11408 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11409 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11410 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11411
11412 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11413
11414 In order to make use of this,
11415 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11416 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11417
11418 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11419 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11420 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11421 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11422 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11423
11424 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11425 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11426 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11427 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11428
11429 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11430 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11431 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11432 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11433 with a CPLD.
11434 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11435 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11436 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11437 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11438 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11439 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11440
11441 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11442
11443 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11444
11445 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11446 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11447 depending on the chips on your board.
11448 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11449 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11450 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11451
11452 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11453 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11454 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11455
11456 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11457 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11458 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11459 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11460
11461 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11462 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11463 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11464 this way.
11465
11466 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11467 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11468 clock rate.
11469 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11470 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11471 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11472
11473 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11474
11475 @example
11476 # Example: 1.234MHz
11477 adapter speed 1234
11478 @end example
11479
11480
11481 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11482
11483 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11484 around Windows filenames.
11485
11486 @example
11487 > echo \a
11488
11489 > echo @{\a@}
11490 \a
11491 > echo "\a"
11492
11493 >
11494 @end example
11495
11496
11497 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11498
11499 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11500 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11501 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11502
11503 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11504 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11505 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11506
11507 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11508 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11509 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11510
11511 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11512
11513 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11514 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11515 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11516 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11517
11518 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11519 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11520 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11521
11522 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11523 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11524
11525 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11526 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11527 memory read caused data abort".
11528
11529 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11530 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11531 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11532 be done, feel free to add this here.
11533
11534 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11535 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11536 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11537 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11538 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11539 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11540 gracefully stops.
11541
11542 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11543 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11544 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11545
11546 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11547 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11548 bytes. Painful...
11549
11550
11551 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11552 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11553
11554 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11555 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11556 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11557 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11558 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11559 reset, everything else should work fine.
11560
11561 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11562 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11563 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11564 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11565
11566 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11567 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11568 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11569 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11570
11571 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11572
11573 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11574 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11575 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11576
11577 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11578 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11579
11580 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11581 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11582 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11583 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11584 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11585 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11586 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11587 clock frequency?
11588
11589 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11590 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11591 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11592 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11593 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11594
11595 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11596
11597 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11598 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11599 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11600 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11601 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11602 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11603 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11604
11605 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11606
11607 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11608 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11609 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11610 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11611
11612 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11613 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11614 particular order?
11615
11616 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11617 the same order used by the hardware.
11618
11619 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11620 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11621 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11622 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11623 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11624 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11625
11626 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11627 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11628 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11629 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11630
11631 @itemize @bullet
11632 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11633 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11634 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11635 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11636 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11637 @end itemize
11638
11639 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11640
11641 @itemize @bullet
11642 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11643 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11644 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11645 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11646 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11647 @end itemize
11648
11649
11650 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11651 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11652 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11653
11654 TODO.
11655
11656 @end enumerate
11657
11658 @node Tcl Crash Course
11659 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11660 @cindex Tcl
11661
11662 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11663 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11664 how the Tcl scripts work.
11665
11666 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11667 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11668 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11669 OpenOCD.
11670
11671 @section Tcl Rule #1
11672 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11673 @enumerate
11674 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11675 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11676 @end enumerate
11677
11678 The Tcl equal is this:
11679
11680 @enumerate
11681 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11682 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11683 @end enumerate
11684
11685 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11686 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11687
11688 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11689 There is a second pair of rules.
11690 @enumerate
11691 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11692 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11693 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11694 in Tcl.
11695 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11696 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11697 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11698 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11699 @end enumerate
11700
11701 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11702 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11703 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11704 Everything is a string}
11705
11706 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11707 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11708 difference is subtle.
11709 @enumerate
11710 @item Parse Time
11711 @item Evaluation Time
11712 @end enumerate
11713
11714 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11715 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11716 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11717
11718 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11719 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11720 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11721 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11722
11723 @itemize @bullet
11724 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11725 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11726 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11727 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11728 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11729 @example
11730 # bash example
11731 X=`date`
11732 echo "The Date is: $X"
11733 # Tcl example
11734 set X [date]
11735 puts "The Date is: $X"
11736 @end example
11737 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11738 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11739 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11740 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11741 is a string}
11742 @example
11743 set x "Dinner"
11744 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11745 @end example
11746 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11747 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11748 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11749 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11750 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11751 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11752 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11753 @end itemize
11754
11755 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11756
11757 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11758
11759 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11760
11761 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11762 the normal way.
11763
11764 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11765 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11766 line is immediately executed.
11767
11768 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11769 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11770
11771 @subsection Command Execution
11772
11773 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11774 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11775 control flow operators.
11776
11777 Commands are executed like this:
11778
11779 @enumerate
11780 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11781 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11782 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11783 @end enumerate
11784
11785 It sort of works like this:
11786 @example
11787 for(;;)@{
11788 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11789
11790 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11791
11792 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11793 @}
11794 @end example
11795
11796 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11797 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11798 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11799 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11800 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11801 ``LookupCommand()''
11802
11803 @subsection The FOR command
11804
11805 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11806 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11807 command just like any other command.
11808
11809 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11810 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11811 are:
11812
11813 @enumerate 0
11814 @item The ascii text 'for'
11815 @item The start text
11816 @item The test expression
11817 @item The next text
11818 @item The body text
11819 @end enumerate
11820
11821 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11822 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11823 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11824 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11825
11826 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11827 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11828
11829 @example
11830 int
11831 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11832 int *argc,
11833 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11834 @end example
11835
11836 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11837 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11838 still operates in the same basic way.
11839
11840 @subsection FOR command implementation
11841
11842 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11843 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11844
11845 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11846
11847 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11848
11849 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11850 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11851 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11852
11853 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11854 expression and returns a value.
11855
11856 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11857 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11858 @example
11859 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11860
11861 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11862
11863 int
11864 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11865 int argc,
11866 char **argv )
11867 @{
11868 if( argc != 5 )@{
11869 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11870 return ERROR;
11871 @}
11872
11873 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11874
11875 // Execute the start statement.
11876 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11877
11878 // Top of loop test
11879 for(;;)@{
11880 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11881 if( i == 0 )
11882 break;
11883
11884 // Execute the body
11885 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11886
11887 // Execute the LOOP part
11888 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11889 @}
11890
11891 // Return no error
11892 SetResult( interp, "" );
11893 return SUCCESS;
11894 @}
11895 @end example
11896
11897 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11898 in the same basic way.
11899
11900 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11901
11902 @subsection source and find commands
11903 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11904 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11905 @*Remember the parsing rules
11906 @enumerate
11907 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11908 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11909 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11910 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11911 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11912 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11913 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11914 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11915 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11916 @end enumerate
11917 @subsection format command
11918 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11919 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11920 @b{sprintf()}.
11921 @b{Example}
11922 @example
11923 set x 6
11924 set y 7
11925 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11926 @end example
11927 @enumerate
11928 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11929 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11930 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11931 @* Refer to Rule #1
11932 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11933 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11934 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11935 @end enumerate
11936 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11937 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11938 @example
11939 #1 Good
11940 proc someproc @{@} @{
11941 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11942 @}
11943 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11944 #2 Good - no variables
11945 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11946 #3 Good Curly Braces
11947 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11948 puts "Time: [date]"
11949 @}
11950 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11951 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11952 @end example
11953 @enumerate
11954 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11955 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11956 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11957 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11958 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11959 command.
11960 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11961 @*There are 4 examples:
11962 @enumerate
11963 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11964 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11965 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11966 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11967 @end enumerate
11968
11969 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11970 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11971 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11972
11973 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11974 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11975 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11976 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11977 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11978 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11979 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11980 @end enumerate
11981 @subsection Global Variables
11982 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11983 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11984 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11985 @example
11986 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11987 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11988 global x #Global variable X
11989 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11990 @}
11991 @end example
11992 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11993 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11994 @example
11995 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11996 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11997 # Create var name
11998 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11999 # Make it a global
12000 global $vn
12001 # Set it.
12002 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12003 @}
12004 @end example
12005 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12006 @example
12007 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12008 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12009 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12010 @}
12011 @end example
12012
12013 @node License
12014 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12015 @include fdl.texi
12016
12017 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12018 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12019 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12020 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12021 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12022 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12023
12024 @printindex cp
12025
12026 @node Command and Driver Index
12027 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12028 @printindex fn
12029
12030 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)